gdb/dwarf: remove line_header::total_length field
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdbsupport/gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "stack.h"
63 #include "ax-gdb.h"
64 #include "dummy-frame.h"
65 #include "interps.h"
66 #include "gdbsupport/format.h"
67 #include "thread-fsm.h"
68 #include "tid-parse.h"
69 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
70 #include "cli/cli-decode.h"
71
72 /* readline include files */
73 #include "readline/tilde.h"
74
75 /* readline defines this. */
76 #undef savestring
77
78 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
79 #include "extension.h"
80 #include <algorithm>
81 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
82 #include "gdbsupport/array-view.h"
83 #include "gdbsupport/gdb_optional.h"
84
85 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
86
87 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
88 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
89
90 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
91
92 static void
93 create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location *location,
94 struct linespec_result *canonical,
95 enum bptype type_wanted);
96
97 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
98 struct linespec_result *,
99 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
100 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
101 enum bptype,
102 enum bpdisp, int, int,
103 int,
104 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
105 int, int, int, unsigned);
106
107 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
108 (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
109 struct program_space *search_pspace);
110
111 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
112 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
113
114 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
115
116 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
117 enum bptype,
118 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
119 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
120 const struct symtab_and_line *);
121
122 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
123 static. */
124 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
125 struct symtab_and_line,
126 enum bptype,
127 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
128
129 static struct breakpoint *
130 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
131 enum bptype type,
132 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
133 int loc_enabled);
134
135 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
136
137 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
138 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
139 enum bptype bptype);
140
141 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
142 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
143 struct obj_section *, int);
144
145 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
146 struct bp_location *loc2);
147
148 static int breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
149 struct bp_location *loc2,
150 bool sw_hw_bps_match = false);
151
152 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
153 const struct address_space *aspace,
154 CORE_ADDR addr);
155
156 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
157 const address_space *,
158 CORE_ADDR, int);
159
160 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
161 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
162
163 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat *bs);
164
165 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
166
167 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
168
169 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
170 enum bptype type,
171 int *other_type_used);
172
173 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
174 int count);
175
176 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
177
178 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
179
180 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
181 insert locations now. */
182 enum ugll_insert_mode
183 {
184 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
185 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
186 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
187 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
188 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
189 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
190 returns true on them.
191
192 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
193 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
194 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
195 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
196 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
197 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
198 the inferior. */
199 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
200
201 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
202 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
203 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
204
205 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
206 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
207 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
208 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
209 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
210 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
211 as no thread is running yet. */
212 UGLL_INSERT
213 };
214
215 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
216
217 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
218
219 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
220
221 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
222
223 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
224
225 static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
226
227 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
228 otherwise. */
229
230 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
231
232 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
233 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
234 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
235 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
236
237 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
238 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
239
240 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
241 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
242
243 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
244 breakpoints. */
245 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
246
247 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
248 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
249
250 /* Tracepoints set on probes. */
251 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
252
253 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
254 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
255
256 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
257 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
258 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
259 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
260 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
261 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
262
263 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
264 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
265 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
266 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
267 dprintf_style_gdb,
268 dprintf_style_call,
269 dprintf_style_agent,
270 NULL
271 };
272 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
273
274 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
275 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
276 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
277 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
278
279 static std::string dprintf_function = "printf";
280
281 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
282 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
283 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
284 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
285 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
286 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
287 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
288
289 static std::string dprintf_channel;
290
291 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
292 has disconnected. */
293 static bool disconnected_dprintf = true;
294
295 struct command_line *
296 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
297 {
298 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
299 }
300
301 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
302 current breakpoint. */
303
304 static bool breakpoint_proceeded;
305
306 const char *
307 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
308 {
309 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
310 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
311 a breakpoint. */
312 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
313
314 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
315 }
316
317 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
318 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
319 if such is available. */
320 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
321
322 static void
323 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
324 struct cmd_list_element *c,
325 const char *value)
326 {
327 gdb_printf (file,
328 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
329 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
330 value);
331 }
332
333 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
334 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
335 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
336 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
337 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
338 static void
339 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
340 struct cmd_list_element *c,
341 const char *value)
342 {
343 gdb_printf (file,
344 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
345 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
346 value);
347 }
348
349 /* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
350 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
351 If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
352 use hardware breakpoints. */
353 static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
354 static void
355 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
356 struct cmd_list_element *c,
357 const char *value)
358 {
359 gdb_printf (file,
360 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
361 value);
362 }
363
364 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
365 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
366 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
367 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
368 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
369 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
370 processing user input. */
371 static bool always_inserted_mode = false;
372
373 static void
374 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
375 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
376 {
377 gdb_printf (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
378 value);
379 }
380
381 /* See breakpoint.h. */
382
383 int
384 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
385 {
386 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
387 {
388 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
389 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
390 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
391 return 1;
392 }
393 else
394 {
395 if (always_inserted_mode)
396 {
397 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
398 are stopped. */
399 return 1;
400 }
401
402 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
403 if (inf->has_execution ()
404 && threads_are_executing (inf->process_target ()))
405 return 1;
406
407 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
408 stopped, we still have events to process. */
409 for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ())
410 if (tp->resumed () && tp->has_pending_waitstatus ())
411 return 1;
412 }
413 return 0;
414 }
415
416 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
417
418 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
419 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
420 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
421 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
422 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
423 condition_evaluation_auto,
424 condition_evaluation_host,
425 condition_evaluation_target,
426 NULL
427 };
428
429 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
430 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
431
432 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
433 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
434 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
435
436 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
437 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
438 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
439 evaluation mode. */
440
441 static const char *
442 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
443 {
444 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
445 {
446 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
447 return condition_evaluation_target;
448 else
449 return condition_evaluation_host;
450 }
451 else
452 return mode;
453 }
454
455 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
456
457 static const char *
458 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
459 {
460 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
461 }
462
463 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
464 otherwise. */
465
466 static int
467 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
468 {
469 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
470
471 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
472 }
473
474 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
475 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
476
477 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
478 static int overlay_events_enabled;
479
480 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
481 bool target_exact_watchpoints = false;
482
483 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
484 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
485 current breakpoint. */
486
487 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
488 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
489 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
490 B = TMP)
491
492 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
493
494 static struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
495
496 /* See breakpoint.h. */
497
498 breakpoint_range
499 all_breakpoints ()
500 {
501 return breakpoint_range (breakpoint_chain);
502 }
503
504 /* See breakpoint.h. */
505
506 breakpoint_safe_range
507 all_breakpoints_safe ()
508 {
509 return breakpoint_safe_range (all_breakpoints ());
510 }
511
512 /* See breakpoint.h. */
513
514 tracepoint_range
515 all_tracepoints ()
516 {
517 return tracepoint_range (breakpoint_chain);
518 }
519
520 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_is_less_than - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
521
522 static std::vector<bp_location *> bp_locations;
523
524 /* See breakpoint.h. */
525
526 const std::vector<bp_location *> &
527 all_bp_locations ()
528 {
529 return bp_locations;
530 }
531
532 /* Range to iterate over breakpoint locations at a given address. */
533
534 struct bp_locations_at_addr_range
535 {
536 using iterator = std::vector<bp_location *>::iterator;
537
538 bp_locations_at_addr_range (CORE_ADDR addr)
539 {
540 struct compare
541 {
542 bool operator() (const bp_location *loc, CORE_ADDR addr_) const
543 { return loc->address < addr_; }
544
545 bool operator() (CORE_ADDR addr_, const bp_location *loc) const
546 { return addr_ < loc->address; }
547 };
548
549 auto it_pair = std::equal_range (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (),
550 addr, compare ());
551
552 m_begin = it_pair.first;
553 m_end = it_pair.second;
554 }
555
556 iterator begin () const
557 { return m_begin; }
558
559 iterator end () const
560 { return m_end; }
561
562 private:
563 iterator m_begin;
564 iterator m_end;
565 };
566
567 /* Return a range to iterate over all breakpoint locations exactly at address
568 ADDR.
569
570 If it's needed to iterate multiple times on the same range, it's possible
571 to save the range in a local variable and use it multiple times:
572
573 auto range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (addr);
574
575 for (bp_location *loc : range)
576 // use loc
577
578 for (bp_location *loc : range)
579 // use loc
580
581 This saves a bit of time, as it avoids re-doing the binary searches to find
582 the range's boundaries. Just remember not to change the bp_locations vector
583 in the mean time, as it could make the range's iterators stale. */
584
585 static bp_locations_at_addr_range
586 all_bp_locations_at_addr (CORE_ADDR addr)
587 {
588 return bp_locations_at_addr_range (addr);
589 }
590
591 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
592 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
593 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
594 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
595 an address you need to read. */
596
597 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
598
599 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
600 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
601 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
602 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
603 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
604
605 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
606
607 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
608 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
609 reported by a target. */
610 static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
611
612 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
613
614 static int breakpoint_count;
615
616 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
617 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
618 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
619 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
620 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
621
622 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
623
624 static int tracepoint_count;
625
626 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
627 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
628 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
629
630 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
631 static int
632 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
633 {
634 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
635 }
636
637 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
638
639 static void
640 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
641 {
642 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
643 breakpoint_count = num;
644 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
645 }
646
647 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
648 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
649 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
650
651 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
652 breakpoint made. */
653
654 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
655 {
656 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
657 }
658
659 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
660 breakpoint made. */
661
662 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
663 {
664 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
665 }
666
667 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
668
669 void
670 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
671 {
672 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
673 b->hit_count = 0;
674 }
675
676 \f
677 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
678 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
679
680 struct breakpoint *
681 get_breakpoint (int num)
682 {
683 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
684 if (b->number == num)
685 return b;
686
687 return nullptr;
688 }
689
690 \f
691
692 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
693 evaluating conditions on its side. */
694
695 static void
696 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
697 {
698 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
699 evaluating conditions and if the user has
700 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
701 side. */
702 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
703 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
704 return;
705
706 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
707 return;
708
709 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
710 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
711 }
712
713 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
714 evaluating conditions on its side. */
715
716 static void
717 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
718 {
719 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
720 evaluating conditions and if the user has
721 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
722 side. */
723 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
724 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
725
726 return;
727
728 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
729 return;
730
731 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
732 }
733
734 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
735 condition_evaluation_mode. */
736
737 static void
738 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
739 struct cmd_list_element *c)
740 {
741 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
742
743 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
744 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
745 {
746 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
747 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
748 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
749 return;
750 }
751
752 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
753 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
754
755 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
756 settings was "auto". */
757 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
758
759 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
760 if (new_mode != old_mode)
761 {
762 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
763 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
764
765 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
766 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
767 */
768
769 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
770 {
771 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
772 target. */
773 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
774 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
775 }
776 else
777 {
778 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
779 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
780 target knows about. */
781 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
782 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
783 loc->needs_update = 1;
784 }
785
786 /* Do the update. */
787 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
788 }
789
790 return;
791 }
792
793 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
794 what "auto" is translating to. */
795
796 static void
797 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
798 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
799 {
800 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
801 gdb_printf (file,
802 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
803 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
804 value,
805 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
806 else
807 gdb_printf (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
808 value);
809 }
810
811 /* Parse COND_STRING in the context of LOC and set as the condition
812 expression of LOC. BP_NUM is the number of LOC's owner, LOC_NUM is
813 the number of LOC within its owner. In case of parsing error, mark
814 LOC as DISABLED_BY_COND. In case of success, unset DISABLED_BY_COND. */
815
816 static void
817 set_breakpoint_location_condition (const char *cond_string, bp_location *loc,
818 int bp_num, int loc_num)
819 {
820 bool has_junk = false;
821 try
822 {
823 expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, loc->address,
824 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
825 if (*cond_string != 0)
826 has_junk = true;
827 else
828 {
829 loc->cond = std::move (new_exp);
830 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled)
831 gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at "
832 "location %d, enabling.\n"),
833 bp_num, loc_num);
834
835 loc->disabled_by_cond = false;
836 }
837 }
838 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
839 {
840 if (loc->enabled)
841 {
842 /* Warn if a user-enabled location is now becoming disabled-by-cond.
843 BP_NUM is 0 if the breakpoint is being defined for the first
844 time using the "break ... if ..." command, and non-zero if
845 already defined. */
846 if (bp_num != 0)
847 warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d.%d, "
848 "disabling:\n %s"), bp_num, loc_num, e.what ());
849 else
850 warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d, "
851 "disabling:\n %s"), loc_num, e.what ());
852 }
853
854 loc->disabled_by_cond = true;
855 }
856
857 if (has_junk)
858 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), cond_string);
859 }
860
861 void
862 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
863 int from_tty, bool force)
864 {
865 if (*exp == 0)
866 {
867 b->cond_string.reset ();
868
869 if (is_watchpoint (b))
870 static_cast<watchpoint *> (b)->cond_exp.reset ();
871 else
872 {
873 int loc_num = 1;
874 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
875 {
876 loc->cond.reset ();
877 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled)
878 gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at "
879 "location %d, enabling.\n"),
880 b->number, loc_num);
881 loc->disabled_by_cond = false;
882 loc_num++;
883
884 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
885 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
886 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
887 }
888 }
889
890 if (from_tty)
891 gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
892 }
893 else
894 {
895 if (is_watchpoint (b))
896 {
897 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
898 const char *arg = exp;
899 expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
900 if (*arg != 0)
901 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
902 watchpoint *w = static_cast<watchpoint *> (b);
903 w->cond_exp = std::move (new_exp);
904 w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
905 }
906 else
907 {
908 /* Parse and set condition expressions. We make two passes.
909 In the first, we parse the condition string to see if it
910 is valid in at least one location. If so, the condition
911 would be accepted. So we go ahead and set the locations'
912 conditions. In case no valid case is found, we throw
913 the error and the condition string will be rejected.
914 This two-pass approach is taken to avoid setting the
915 state of locations in case of a reject. */
916 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
917 {
918 try
919 {
920 const char *arg = exp;
921 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
922 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
923 if (*arg != 0)
924 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
925 break;
926 }
927 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
928 {
929 /* Condition string is invalid. If this happens to
930 be the last loc, abandon (if not forced) or continue
931 (if forced). */
932 if (loc->next == nullptr && !force)
933 throw;
934 }
935 }
936
937 /* If we reach here, the condition is valid at some locations. */
938 int loc_num = 1;
939 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
940 {
941 set_breakpoint_location_condition (exp, loc, b->number, loc_num);
942 loc_num++;
943 }
944 }
945
946 /* We know that the new condition parsed successfully. The
947 condition string of the breakpoint can be safely updated. */
948 b->cond_string = make_unique_xstrdup (exp);
949 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
950 }
951 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
952
953 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
954 }
955
956 /* See breakpoint.h. */
957
958 void
959 set_breakpoint_condition (int bpnum, const char *exp, int from_tty,
960 bool force)
961 {
962 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
963 if (b->number == bpnum)
964 {
965 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
966 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
967 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
968 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
969 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
970
971 if (extlang != NULL)
972 {
973 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
974 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
975 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
976 }
977 set_breakpoint_condition (b, exp, from_tty, force);
978
979 if (is_breakpoint (b))
980 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
981
982 return;
983 }
984
985 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bpnum);
986 }
987
988 /* The options for the "condition" command. */
989
990 struct condition_command_opts
991 {
992 /* For "-force". */
993 bool force_condition = false;
994 };
995
996 static const gdb::option::option_def condition_command_option_defs[] = {
997
998 gdb::option::flag_option_def<condition_command_opts> {
999 "force",
1000 [] (condition_command_opts *opts) { return &opts->force_condition; },
1001 N_("Set the condition even if it is invalid for all current locations."),
1002 },
1003
1004 };
1005
1006 /* Create an option_def_group for the "condition" options, with
1007 CC_OPTS as context. */
1008
1009 static inline gdb::option::option_def_group
1010 make_condition_command_options_def_group (condition_command_opts *cc_opts)
1011 {
1012 return {{condition_command_option_defs}, cc_opts};
1013 }
1014
1015 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
1016
1017 static void
1018 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
1019 completion_tracker &tracker,
1020 const char *text, const char * /*word*/)
1021 {
1022 bool has_no_arguments = (*text == '\0');
1023 condition_command_opts cc_opts;
1024 const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts);
1025 if (gdb::option::complete_options
1026 (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group))
1027 return;
1028
1029 text = skip_spaces (text);
1030 const char *space = skip_to_space (text);
1031 if (*space == '\0')
1032 {
1033 int len;
1034
1035 if (text[0] == '$')
1036 {
1037 tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (1);
1038 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1039 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
1040 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
1041 return;
1042 }
1043
1044 /* Suggest the "-force" flag if no arguments are given. If
1045 arguments were passed, they either already include the flag,
1046 or we are beyond the point of suggesting it because it's
1047 positionally the first argument. */
1048 if (has_no_arguments)
1049 gdb::option::complete_on_all_options (tracker, group);
1050
1051 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1052 len = strlen (text);
1053
1054 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
1055 {
1056 char number[50];
1057
1058 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1059
1060 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1061 tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number));
1062 }
1063
1064 return;
1065 }
1066
1067 /* We're completing the expression part. Skip the breakpoint num. */
1068 const char *exp_start = skip_spaces (space);
1069 tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (exp_start - text);
1070 text = exp_start;
1071 const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text);
1072 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
1073 }
1074
1075 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1076
1077 static void
1078 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1079 {
1080 const char *p;
1081 int bnum;
1082
1083 if (arg == 0)
1084 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1085
1086 p = arg;
1087
1088 /* Check if the "-force" flag was passed. */
1089 condition_command_opts cc_opts;
1090 const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts);
1091 gdb::option::process_options
1092 (&p, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group);
1093
1094 bnum = get_number (&p);
1095 if (bnum == 0)
1096 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1097
1098 set_breakpoint_condition (bnum, p, from_tty, cc_opts.force_condition);
1099 }
1100
1101 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1102 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1103 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1104
1105 static void
1106 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1107 {
1108 struct command_line *c;
1109
1110 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1111 {
1112 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1113 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1114 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1115
1116 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1117 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1118
1119 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1120 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1121 command directly. */
1122 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1123 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1124
1125 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1126 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1127 }
1128 }
1129
1130 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1131 {
1132 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1133 };
1134
1135 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1136
1137 static bool
1138 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1139 {
1140 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1141 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1142 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1143 }
1144
1145 static bool
1146 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1147 {
1148 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1149 }
1150
1151 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1152
1153 bool
1154 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1155 {
1156 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1157 }
1158
1159 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1160 TYPE. */
1161
1162 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1163 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1164 {
1165 breakpoint *b;
1166
1167 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1168 b = new tracepoint ();
1169 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1170 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1171 else
1172 b = new breakpoint ();
1173
1174 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1175 }
1176
1177 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1178 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1179 found. */
1180
1181 static void
1182 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1183 struct command_line *commands)
1184 {
1185 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1186 {
1187 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1188 struct command_line *c;
1189 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1190
1191 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1192 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1193 ones might not. */
1194 t->step_count = 0;
1195
1196 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1197 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1198 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1199 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1200 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1201 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1202 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1203 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1204 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1205 tracepoint's context. */
1206 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1207 {
1208 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1209 {
1210 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1211 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1212 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1213 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1214 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1215 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1216
1217 if (while_stepping)
1218 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1219 "can be used only once"));
1220 else
1221 while_stepping = c;
1222 }
1223
1224 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1225 }
1226 if (while_stepping)
1227 {
1228 struct command_line *c2;
1229
1230 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1231 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1232 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1233 {
1234 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1235 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1236 }
1237 }
1238 }
1239 else
1240 {
1241 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1242 }
1243 }
1244
1245 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1246 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1247
1248 std::vector<breakpoint *>
1249 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1250 {
1251 std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
1252
1253 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
1254 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1255 {
1256 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
1257 if (loc->address == addr)
1258 found.push_back (b);
1259 }
1260
1261 return found;
1262 }
1263
1264 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1265 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1266
1267 void
1268 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1269 counted_command_line &&commands)
1270 {
1271 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1272
1273 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1274 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1275 }
1276
1277 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1278 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1279 commands. */
1280
1281 void
1282 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1283 {
1284 int old_silent = b->silent;
1285
1286 b->silent = silent;
1287 if (old_silent != silent)
1288 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1289 }
1290
1291 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1292 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1293
1294 void
1295 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1296 {
1297 int old_thread = b->thread;
1298
1299 b->thread = thread;
1300 if (old_thread != thread)
1301 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1305 breakpoint work for any task. */
1306
1307 void
1308 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1309 {
1310 int old_task = b->task;
1311
1312 b->task = task;
1313 if (old_task != task)
1314 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1315 }
1316
1317 static void
1318 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1319 struct command_line *control)
1320 {
1321 counted_command_line cmd;
1322 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1323 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1324 list of command by just typing "end". */
1325 bool cmd_read = false;
1326
1327 std::string new_arg;
1328
1329 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1330 {
1331 /* Argument not explicitly given. Synthesize it. */
1332 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1333 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1334 breakpoint_count);
1335 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1336 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1337 }
1338 else
1339 {
1340 /* Create a copy of ARG. This is needed because the "commands"
1341 command may be coming from a script. In that case, the read
1342 line buffer is going to be overwritten in the lambda of
1343 'map_breakpoint_numbers' below when reading the next line
1344 before we are are done parsing the breakpoint numbers. */
1345 new_arg = arg;
1346 }
1347 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1348
1349 map_breakpoint_numbers
1350 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1351 {
1352 if (!cmd_read)
1353 {
1354 gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
1355 if (control != NULL)
1356 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1357 else
1358 {
1359 std::string str
1360 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1361 "%s, one per line."),
1362 arg);
1363
1364 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1365 {
1366 validate_actionline (line, b);
1367 };
1368 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1369 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1370 validator = do_validate;
1371
1372 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1373 }
1374 cmd_read = true;
1375 }
1376
1377 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1378 do anything. */
1379 if (b->commands != cmd)
1380 {
1381 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1382 b->commands = cmd;
1383 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1384 }
1385 });
1386 }
1387
1388 static void
1389 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1390 {
1391 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1392 }
1393
1394 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1395 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1396
1397 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1398 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1399 enum command_control_type
1400 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1401 {
1402 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1403 return simple_control;
1404 }
1405
1406 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1407
1408 static int
1409 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1410 {
1411 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1412 return 0;
1413 if (!bl->inserted)
1414 return 0;
1415 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1416 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1417 return 0;
1418 return 1;
1419 }
1420
1421 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1422 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1423 contents.
1424
1425 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1426 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1427 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1428
1429 static void
1430 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1431 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1432 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1433 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1434 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1435 {
1436 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1437 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1438 int bp_size = 0;
1439 int bptoffset = 0;
1440
1441 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1442 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1443 {
1444 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1445 return;
1446 }
1447
1448 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1449 we need to copy. */
1450 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1451 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1452
1453 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1454 {
1455 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1456 reading. */
1457 return;
1458 }
1459
1460 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1461 {
1462 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1463 reading. */
1464 return;
1465 }
1466
1467 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1468 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1469 {
1470 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1471 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1472 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1473 bp_addr = memaddr;
1474 }
1475
1476 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1477 {
1478 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1479 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1480 }
1481
1482 if (readbuf != NULL)
1483 {
1484 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1485 shadow_contents buffer. */
1486 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1487 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1488 + target_info->shadow_len));
1489
1490 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1491 shadow. */
1492 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1493 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1494 }
1495 else
1496 {
1497 const unsigned char *bp;
1498 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1499 int placed_size;
1500
1501 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1502 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1503 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1504
1505 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1506 address. */
1507 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1508
1509 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1510 breakpoint's INSN. */
1511 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1512 }
1513 }
1514
1515 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1516 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1517
1518 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1519 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1520 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1521
1522 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1523 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1524 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1525 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1526 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1527 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1528 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1529 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1530 and:
1531 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1532
1533 void
1534 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1535 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1536 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1537 {
1538 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1539 search. */
1540 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1541
1542 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1543 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1544 report higher one. */
1545
1546 bc_l = 0;
1547 bc_r = bp_locations.size ();
1548 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1549 {
1550 struct bp_location *bl;
1551
1552 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1553 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1554
1555 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1556 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1557 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1558 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1559
1560 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1561 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1562 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1563
1564 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1565 >= bl->address)
1566 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1567 <= memaddr))
1568 bc_l = bc;
1569 else
1570 bc_r = bc;
1571 }
1572
1573 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1574 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1575 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1576 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1577 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1578 B:
1579
1580 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1581
1582 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1583 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1584 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1585 and L2. */
1586 while (bc_l > 0
1587 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1588 bc_l--;
1589
1590 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1591
1592 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations.size (); bc++)
1593 {
1594 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1595
1596 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1597 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1598 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1599 bl->owner->number);
1600
1601 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1602 content. */
1603
1604 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1605 && (memaddr + len
1606 <= (bl->address
1607 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)))
1608 break;
1609
1610 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1611 continue;
1612
1613 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1614 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1615 }
1616 }
1617
1618 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1619
1620 bool
1621 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1622 {
1623 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1624 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1625 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1626 }
1627
1628 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1629
1630 static bool
1631 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1632 {
1633 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1634 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1635 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1636 }
1637
1638 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1639
1640 bool
1641 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1642 {
1643 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1644 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1645 }
1646
1647 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1648 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1649 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1650 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1651 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1652 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1653 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1654 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1655
1656 static int
1657 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1658 {
1659 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1660 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1661 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1662 && !inferior_thread ()->executing ())));
1663 }
1664
1665 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1666 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1667
1668 static void
1669 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1670 {
1671 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1672 {
1673 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1674 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1675 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1676 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1677 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1678 }
1679 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1680 }
1681
1682 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1683 watchpoint W. */
1684
1685 static struct value *
1686 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1687 {
1688 struct value *bit_val;
1689
1690 if (val == NULL)
1691 return NULL;
1692
1693 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1694
1695 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1696 w->val_bitpos,
1697 w->val_bitsize,
1698 value_contents_for_printing (val).data (),
1699 value_offset (val),
1700 val);
1701
1702 return bit_val;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1706 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1707 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1708 to be able to report stops. */
1709
1710 static void
1711 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1712 struct program_space *pspace)
1713 {
1714 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1715
1716 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1717 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1718 b->loc->address = -1;
1719 b->loc->length = -1;
1720 }
1721
1722 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1723 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1724
1725 static bool
1726 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1727 {
1728 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1729 && b->loc != NULL
1730 && b->loc->next == NULL
1731 && b->loc->address == -1
1732 && b->loc->length == -1);
1733 }
1734
1735 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1736 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1737 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1738 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1739 in b->loc->cond.
1740 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1741
1742 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1743 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1744 it.
1745
1746 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1747 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1748 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1749 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1750 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1751 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1752 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1753 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1754
1755 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1756 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1757 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1758 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1759 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1760 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1761 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1762 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1763 not changed.
1764
1765 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1766 hardware watchpoints:
1767
1768 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1769 called several times when GDB stops.
1770
1771 [linux]
1772 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1773 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1774 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1775 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1776 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1777 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1778 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1779 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1780 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1781 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1782 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1783
1784 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1785 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1786
1787 static void
1788 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1789 {
1790 int within_current_scope;
1791 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1792 int frame_saved;
1793
1794 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1795 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1796 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1797 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1798 return;
1799
1800 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1801 return;
1802
1803 frame_saved = 0;
1804
1805 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1806 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1807 within_current_scope = 1;
1808 else
1809 {
1810 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1811 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1812 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1813
1814 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1815 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1816 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1817 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1818 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1819 return;
1820
1821 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1822 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1823 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1824 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1825 selected frame. */
1826 frame_saved = 1;
1827 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1828
1829 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1830 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1831 if (within_current_scope)
1832 select_frame (fi);
1833 }
1834
1835 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1836 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1837 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1838 b->loc = NULL;
1839
1840 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1841 {
1842 const char *s;
1843
1844 b->exp.reset ();
1845 s = (b->exp_string_reparse
1846 ? b->exp_string_reparse.get ()
1847 : b->exp_string.get ());
1848 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1849 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1850 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1851 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1852 be completely different objects. */
1853 b->val = NULL;
1854 b->val_valid = false;
1855
1856 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1857 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1858 locations (re)created below. */
1859 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1860 {
1861 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1862
1863 s = b->cond_string.get ();
1864 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1865 }
1866 }
1867
1868 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1869 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1870 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1871 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1872 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1873 if (!target_has_execution ())
1874 {
1875 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1876 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1877 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1878 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1879 {
1880 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1881 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1882 else
1883 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1884 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1885 }
1886 }
1887 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1888 {
1889 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1890 struct value *v, *result;
1891 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1892
1893 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &v, &result,
1894 &val_chain, false);
1895
1896 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1897 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1898 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1899 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1900 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1901 watchpoints. */
1902 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1903 {
1904 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1905 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1906 b->val = release_value (v);
1907 b->val_valid = true;
1908 }
1909
1910 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1911
1912 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1913 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1914 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1915 {
1916 v = iter.get ();
1917
1918 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1919 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1920 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1921 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1922 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1923 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1924 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1925 {
1926 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1927
1928 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1929 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1930 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1931 if (v == result
1932 || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1933 && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1934 {
1935 CORE_ADDR addr;
1936 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1937 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1938 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1939
1940 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1941 {
1942 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1943 sub-expression. */
1944 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1945 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1946 }
1947 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1948 {
1949 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1950 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1951 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1952 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1953 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1954 }
1955
1956 addr = value_address (v);
1957 if (bitsize != 0)
1958 {
1959 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1960 addr += bitpos / 8;
1961 }
1962
1963 type = hw_write;
1964 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1965 type = hw_read;
1966 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1967 type = hw_access;
1968
1969 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1970 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1971 ;
1972 *tmp = loc;
1973 loc->gdbarch = value_type (v)->arch ();
1974
1975 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1976 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1977
1978 if (bitsize != 0)
1979 {
1980 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1981 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1982 }
1983 else
1984 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1985
1986 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1987 }
1988 }
1989 }
1990
1991 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1992 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1993 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1994 is started. */
1995 if (reparse)
1996 {
1997 int reg_cnt;
1998 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1999
2000 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
2001
2002 if (reg_cnt)
2003 {
2004 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
2005 enum bptype type;
2006
2007 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
2008 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
2009 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
2010
2011 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
2012 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
2013 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
2014 this watchpoint in as well. */
2015
2016 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
2017 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
2018 hardware watchpoint type. */
2019 type = b->type;
2020 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
2021 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
2022
2023 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
2024 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
2025 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
2026 through watch_command), so always account for it
2027 manually. */
2028
2029 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
2030 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
2031
2032 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
2033 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
2034
2035 target_resources_ok
2036 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
2037 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
2038 {
2039 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
2040
2041 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
2042 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
2043 "hardware watchpoint."));
2044 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
2045 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
2046 "resources for this watchpoint."));
2047
2048 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
2049 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
2050 }
2051 else
2052 {
2053 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
2054 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
2055 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
2056 nop. */
2057 b->type = type;
2058 }
2059 }
2060 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
2061 {
2062 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2063 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2064 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2065 else
2066 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2067 "read/access watchpoint."));
2068 }
2069 else
2070 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
2071
2072 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2073 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2074 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
2075 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2076 }
2077
2078 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2079 above left it without any location set up. But,
2080 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2081 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2082 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
2083 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
2084 }
2085 else if (!within_current_scope)
2086 {
2087 gdb_printf (_("\
2088 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2089 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2090 b->number);
2091 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2092 }
2093
2094 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2095 if (frame_saved)
2096 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2097 }
2098
2099
2100 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2101 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2102 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2103 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2104 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2105 static int
2106 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2107 {
2108 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2109 return 0;
2110
2111 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2112 return 0;
2113
2114 if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond
2115 || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2116 return 0;
2117
2118 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2119 return 0;
2120
2121 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2122 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2123 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2124 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2125 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2126 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2127 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2128 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2129 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2130 return 0;
2131
2132 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2133 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2134 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2135 a breakpoint. */
2136 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2137 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2138 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2139 bl->address)
2140 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2141 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2142 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2143 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2144 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2145 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2146 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2147 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2148 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2149 {
2150 infrun_debug_printf ("skipping breakpoint: stepping past insn at: %s",
2151 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2152 return 0;
2153 }
2154
2155 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2156 instruction that triggered one. */
2157 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2158 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2159 {
2160 infrun_debug_printf ("stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2161 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d",
2162 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), bl->length);
2163 return 0;
2164 }
2165
2166 return 1;
2167 }
2168
2169 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2170 that the location is not duplicated. */
2171
2172 static int
2173 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2174 {
2175 int result;
2176 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2177
2178 bl->duplicate = 0;
2179 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2180 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2181 return result;
2182 }
2183
2184 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2185 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2186 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2187 any error during parsing. */
2188
2189 static agent_expr_up
2190 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2191 {
2192 if (cond == NULL)
2193 return NULL;
2194
2195 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2196
2197 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2198 that may show up. */
2199 try
2200 {
2201 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2202 }
2203
2204 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2205 {
2206 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2207 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2208 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2209 }
2210
2211 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2212 return aexpr;
2213 }
2214
2215 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2216 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2217 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2218 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2219 one of them is true. */
2220
2221 static void
2222 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2223 {
2224 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2225 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2226
2227 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2228 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2229
2230 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2231 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2232 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2233 side. */
2234 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2235 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2236 return;
2237
2238 auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address);
2239
2240 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2241 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent
2242 expression bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to
2243 send conditions to the target since this location will always
2244 trigger and generate a response back to GDB. Note we consider
2245 all locations at the same address irrespective of type, i.e.,
2246 even if the locations aren't considered duplicates (e.g.,
2247 software breakpoint and hardware breakpoint at the same
2248 address). */
2249 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2250 {
2251 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2252 {
2253 if (modified)
2254 {
2255 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2256 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2257 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2258 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2259 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2260 loc->cond.get ());
2261 }
2262
2263 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2264 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2265 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2266 {
2267 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2268 break;
2269 }
2270 }
2271 }
2272
2273 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2274 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2275 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2276
2277 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2278 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2279 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2280 {
2281 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2282 {
2283 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2284 {
2285 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2286 located. */
2287 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2288 return;
2289
2290 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2291 }
2292 }
2293 }
2294
2295 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a
2296 condition list for this location's address. If we have software
2297 and hardware locations at the same address, they aren't
2298 considered duplicates, but we still marge all the conditions
2299 anyway, as it's simpler, and doesn't really make a practical
2300 difference. */
2301 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2302 if (loc->cond
2303 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2304 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2305 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2306 && loc->enabled
2307 && !loc->disabled_by_cond)
2308 {
2309 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2310 to send the conditions to the target. */
2311 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2312 }
2313
2314 return;
2315 }
2316
2317 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2318 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2319 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2320
2321 static agent_expr_up
2322 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2323 {
2324 const char *cmdrest;
2325 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2326 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2327
2328 if (cmd == NULL)
2329 return NULL;
2330
2331 cmdrest = cmd;
2332
2333 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2334 ++cmdrest;
2335 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2336
2337 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2338 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2339
2340 format_start = cmdrest;
2341
2342 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2343
2344 format_end = cmdrest;
2345
2346 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2347 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2348
2349 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2350
2351 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2352 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2353
2354 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2355 cmdrest++;
2356 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2357
2358 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2359
2360 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2361 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2362 {
2363 const char *cmd1;
2364
2365 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2366 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2367 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2368 cmdrest = cmd1;
2369 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2370 ++cmdrest;
2371 }
2372
2373 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2374
2375 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2376 that may show up. */
2377 try
2378 {
2379 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2380 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2381 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2382 }
2383 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2384 {
2385 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2386 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2387 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2388 }
2389
2390 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2391 return aexpr;
2392 }
2393
2394 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2395 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2396 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2397
2398 static void
2399 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2400 {
2401 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2402 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2403
2404 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2405 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2406
2407 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2408 return;
2409
2410 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2411 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2412 return;
2413
2414 auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address);
2415
2416 /* For now, if we have any location at the same address that isn't a
2417 dprintf, don't install the target-side commands, as that would
2418 make the breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2419 control. */
2420 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2421 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2422 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2423 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2424 return;
2425
2426 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2427 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2428 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2429 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2430 response back to GDB. */
2431 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2432 {
2433 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2434 {
2435 if (modified)
2436 {
2437 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2438 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2439 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2440 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2441 loc->cmd_bytecode
2442 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2443 loc->owner->extra_string.get ());
2444 }
2445
2446 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2447 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2448 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2449 {
2450 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2451 break;
2452 }
2453 }
2454 }
2455
2456 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2457 and so clean up. */
2458 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2459 {
2460 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2461 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2462 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2463 {
2464 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2465 located. */
2466 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2467 return;
2468
2469 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2470 }
2471 }
2472
2473 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command
2474 list for all duplicate locations at this location's address.
2475 Note that here we must care for whether the breakpoint location
2476 types are considered duplicates, otherwise, say, if we have a
2477 software and hardware location at the same address, the target
2478 could end up running the commands twice. For the moment, we only
2479 support targets-side commands with dprintf, but it doesn't hurt
2480 to be pedantically correct in case that changes. */
2481 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2482 if (breakpoint_locations_match (bl, loc)
2483 && loc->owner->extra_string
2484 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2485 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2486 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2487 && loc->enabled
2488 && !loc->disabled_by_cond)
2489 {
2490 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2491 to send the commands to the target. */
2492 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2493 }
2494
2495 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2496 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2497 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2498 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2499 }
2500
2501 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2502 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2503 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2504 registers state. */
2505
2506 static int
2507 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2508 {
2509 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2510 {
2511 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2512 struct regcache *regcache;
2513
2514 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2515
2516 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2517 regcache, addr);
2518 }
2519 else
2520 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2521 }
2522
2523 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2524 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2525 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2526 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2527 -1 for failure.
2528
2529 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2530 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2531 static int
2532 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2533 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2534 int *disabled_breaks,
2535 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2536 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2537 {
2538 gdb_exception bp_excpt;
2539
2540 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2541 return 0;
2542
2543 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2544 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2545 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2546 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2547 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2548 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2549 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2550 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2551 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2552 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2553 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2554 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2555
2556 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2557 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2558 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2559 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2560
2561 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2562 {
2563 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2564 build_target_command_list (bl);
2565 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2566 bl->needs_update = 0;
2567 }
2568
2569 /* If "set breakpoint auto-hw" is "on" and a software breakpoint was
2570 set at a read-only address, then a breakpoint location will have
2571 been changed to hardware breakpoint before we get here. If it is
2572 "off" however, error out before actually trying to insert the
2573 breakpoint, with a nicer error message. */
2574 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2575 && !automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2576 {
2577 mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address);
2578
2579 if (mr != nullptr && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2580 {
2581 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,
2582 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2583 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2584 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2585 bl->owner->number,
2586 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2587 return 1;
2588 }
2589 }
2590
2591 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2592 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2593 {
2594 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2595 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2596 || bl->section == NULL
2597 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2598 {
2599 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2600 try
2601 {
2602 int val;
2603
2604 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2605 if (val)
2606 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2607 }
2608 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2609 {
2610 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2611 }
2612 }
2613 else
2614 {
2615 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2616 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2617 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2618 {
2619 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2620 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2621 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2622 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2623 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2624 bl->owner->number);
2625 else
2626 {
2627 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2628 bl->section);
2629 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2630 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2631 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2632
2633 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2634 try
2635 {
2636 int val;
2637
2638 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2639 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2640 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2641 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2642 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2643 if (val)
2644 bp_excpt
2645 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2646 }
2647 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2648 {
2649 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2650 }
2651
2652 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2653 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,
2654 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2655 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2656 bl->owner->number);
2657 }
2658 }
2659 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2660 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2661 {
2662 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2663 try
2664 {
2665 int val;
2666
2667 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2668 if (val)
2669 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2670 }
2671 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2672 {
2673 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2674 }
2675 }
2676 else
2677 {
2678 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2679 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2680 return 0;
2681 }
2682 }
2683
2684 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2685 {
2686 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2687
2688 /* If the target has closed then it will have deleted any
2689 breakpoints inserted within the target inferior, as a result
2690 any further attempts to interact with the breakpoint objects
2691 is not possible. Just rethrow the error. */
2692 if (bp_excpt.error == TARGET_CLOSE_ERROR)
2693 throw bp_excpt;
2694 gdb_assert (bl->owner != nullptr);
2695
2696 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2697 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2698 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2699 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2700 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2701 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2702 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2703 errors as memory errors. */
2704 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2705 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2706 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2707 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2708 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2709 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2710 bl->address)))
2711 {
2712 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2713 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2714 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2715 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2716 {
2717 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,
2718 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2719 bl->owner->number);
2720 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,
2721 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2722 "library breakpoints:\n");
2723 }
2724 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2725 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,
2726 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2727 return 0;
2728 }
2729 else
2730 {
2731 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2732 {
2733 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2734 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2735 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,
2736 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2737 bl->owner->number,
2738 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2739 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2740 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2741 bp_excpt.what ());
2742 }
2743 else
2744 {
2745 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2746 {
2747 std::string message
2748 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2749 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2750
2751 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,
2752 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2753 "%s\n",
2754 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2755 }
2756 else
2757 {
2758 gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream,
2759 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2760 bl->owner->number,
2761 bp_excpt.what ());
2762 }
2763 }
2764 return 1;
2765
2766 }
2767 }
2768 else
2769 bl->inserted = 1;
2770
2771 return 0;
2772 }
2773
2774 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2775 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2776 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2777 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2778 {
2779 int val;
2780
2781 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2782 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2783
2784 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2785
2786 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2787 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2788 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2789 {
2790 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2791 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2792 of this one. */
2793 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
2794 if (loc != bl
2795 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2796 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2797 {
2798 bl->duplicate = 1;
2799 bl->inserted = 1;
2800 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2801 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2802 val = 0;
2803 break;
2804 }
2805
2806 if (val == 1)
2807 {
2808 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2809 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2810
2811 if (val)
2812 /* Back to the original value. */
2813 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2814 }
2815 }
2816
2817 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2818 }
2819
2820 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2821 {
2822 int val;
2823
2824 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2825 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2826
2827 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2828 if (val)
2829 {
2830 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2831
2832 if (val == 1)
2833 warning (_("\
2834 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2835 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2836 else
2837 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2838 }
2839
2840 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2841
2842 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2843 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2844 so just return success. */
2845 return 0;
2846 }
2847
2848 return 0;
2849 }
2850
2851 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2852 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2853 PSPACE anymore. */
2854
2855 void
2856 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2857 {
2858 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2859 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
2860 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2861 delete_breakpoint (b);
2862
2863 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2864 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2865 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
2866 {
2867 struct bp_location *tmp;
2868
2869 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2870 {
2871 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2872 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2873 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2874 else
2875 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2876 if (tmp->next == loc)
2877 {
2878 tmp->next = loc->next;
2879 break;
2880 }
2881 }
2882 }
2883
2884 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2885 removed locations above. */
2886 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2887 }
2888
2889 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2890 Throws exception on any error.
2891 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2892 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2893 void
2894 insert_breakpoints (void)
2895 {
2896 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
2897 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2898 {
2899 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2900
2901 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2902 }
2903
2904 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2905 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2906 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. Also,
2907 update_global_location_list tries to "upgrade" software
2908 breakpoints to hardware breakpoints to handle "set breakpoint
2909 auto-hw", so we need to call it even if we don't have new
2910 locations. */
2911 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2912 }
2913
2914 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2915 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2916 always-inserted mode. */
2917
2918 static void
2919 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2920 {
2921 int error_flag = 0;
2922 int val = 0;
2923 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2924 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2925 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2926
2927 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2928
2929 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2930 there was an error. */
2931 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2932
2933 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2934
2935 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
2936 {
2937 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2938 breakpoints. */
2939 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2940 continue;
2941
2942 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2943 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2944 deletion of breakpoints. */
2945 if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
2946 continue;
2947
2948 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2949
2950 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2951 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2952 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2953 insert breakpoints. */
2954 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2955 && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()))
2956 continue;
2957
2958 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2959 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2960 if (val)
2961 error_flag = val;
2962 }
2963
2964 if (error_flag)
2965 {
2966 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2967 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2968 }
2969 }
2970
2971 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2972
2973 static void
2974 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2975 {
2976 int error_flag = 0;
2977 int val = 0;
2978 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2979 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2980 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2981
2982 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2983
2984 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2985 there was an error. */
2986 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2987
2988 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2989
2990 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
2991 {
2992 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2993 continue;
2994
2995 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2996 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2997 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2998 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2999 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3000 continue;
3001
3002 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3003
3004 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3005 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3006 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3007 insert breakpoints. */
3008 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3009 && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()))
3010 continue;
3011
3012 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3013 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3014 if (val)
3015 error_flag = val;
3016 }
3017
3018 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3019 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3020 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
3021 {
3022 int some_failed = 0;
3023
3024 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3025 continue;
3026
3027 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3028 continue;
3029
3030 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3031 continue;
3032
3033 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
3034 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3035 {
3036 some_failed = 1;
3037 break;
3038 }
3039
3040 if (some_failed)
3041 {
3042 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
3043 if (loc->inserted)
3044 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3045
3046 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3047 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3048 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3049 bpt->number);
3050 error_flag = -1;
3051 }
3052 }
3053
3054 if (error_flag)
3055 {
3056 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3057 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3058 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3059 {
3060 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3061 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3062 }
3063 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3064 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3065 }
3066 }
3067
3068 /* Used when the program stops.
3069 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3070 removing a breakpoint location. */
3071
3072 int
3073 remove_breakpoints (void)
3074 {
3075 int val = 0;
3076
3077 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3078 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3079 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3080
3081 return val;
3082 }
3083
3084 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3085 that thread. */
3086
3087 static void
3088 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3089 {
3090 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3091 {
3092 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3093 {
3094 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3095
3096 gdb_printf (_("\
3097 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3098 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3099
3100 /* Hide it from the user. */
3101 b->number = 0;
3102 }
3103 }
3104 }
3105
3106 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3107
3108 void
3109 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3110 {
3111 int val;
3112
3113 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3114 {
3115 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3116 continue;
3117
3118 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3119 {
3120 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3121 if (val != 0)
3122 return;
3123 }
3124 }
3125 }
3126
3127 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3128
3129 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3130 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3131 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3132 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3133 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3134 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3135 static void
3136 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3137 {
3138 if (internal)
3139 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3140 else
3141 {
3142 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3143 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3144 }
3145 }
3146
3147 static struct breakpoint *
3148 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3149 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3150 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3151 {
3152 symtab_and_line sal;
3153 sal.pc = address;
3154 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3155 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3156
3157 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3158 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3159 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3160
3161 return b;
3162 }
3163
3164 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3165 {
3166 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3167 };
3168 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3169
3170 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3171 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3172 {
3173 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3174 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym;
3175
3176 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3177 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
3178
3179 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3180 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3181
3182 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3183 references. */
3184 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3185
3186 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3187 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym;
3188
3189 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3190 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym;
3191
3192 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3193 int exception_searched = 0;
3194
3195 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3196 references. */
3197 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3198 };
3199
3200 static const struct objfile_key<breakpoint_objfile_data>
3201 breakpoint_objfile_key;
3202
3203 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3204 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3205
3206 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3207
3208 static int
3209 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3210 {
3211 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3212 }
3213
3214 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3215 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3216
3217 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3218 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3219 {
3220 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3221
3222 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile);
3223 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3224 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile);
3225 return bp_objfile_data;
3226 }
3227
3228 static void
3229 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3230 {
3231 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3232
3233 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3234 {
3235 struct breakpoint *b;
3236 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3237 CORE_ADDR addr;
3238 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3239
3240 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3241
3242 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3243 continue;
3244
3245 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3246 {
3247 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3248
3249 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3250 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3251 {
3252 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3253 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3254 continue;
3255 }
3256 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3257 }
3258
3259 addr = bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.value_address ();
3260 b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr,
3261 bp_overlay_event,
3262 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3263 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3264 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3265 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3266
3267 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3268 {
3269 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3270 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3271 }
3272 else
3273 {
3274 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3275 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3276 }
3277 }
3278 }
3279
3280 /* Install a master longjmp breakpoint for OBJFILE using a probe. Return
3281 true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3282
3283 static bool
3284 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile)
3285 {
3286 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3287 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3288 = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3289
3290 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3291 {
3292 std::vector<probe *> ret
3293 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3294
3295 if (!ret.empty ())
3296 {
3297 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3298 probe *p = ret[0];
3299
3300 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3301 {
3302 /* We cannot use the probe interface here,
3303 because it does not know how to evaluate
3304 arguments. */
3305 ret.clear ();
3306 }
3307 }
3308 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3309 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3310 }
3311
3312 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3313 return false;
3314
3315 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3316 {
3317 struct breakpoint *b;
3318
3319 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3320 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3321 bp_longjmp_master,
3322 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3323 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3324 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3325 }
3326
3327 return true;
3328 }
3329
3330 /* Install master longjmp breakpoints for OBJFILE using longjmp_names.
3331 Return true if at least one breakpoint was installed. */
3332
3333 static bool
3334 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (objfile *objfile)
3335 {
3336 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3337 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3338 return false;
3339
3340 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3341 = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3342 unsigned int installed_bp = 0;
3343
3344 for (int i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3345 {
3346 struct breakpoint *b;
3347 const char *func_name;
3348 CORE_ADDR addr;
3349 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3350
3351 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3352 continue;
3353
3354 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3355 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3356 {
3357 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3358
3359 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3360 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3361 {
3362 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3363 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3364 continue;
3365 }
3366 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3367 }
3368
3369 addr = bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].value_address ();
3370 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3371 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3372 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3373 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3374 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3375 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3376 installed_bp++;
3377 }
3378
3379 return installed_bp > 0;
3380 }
3381
3382 /* Create a master longjmp breakpoint. */
3383
3384 static void
3385 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3386 {
3387 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3388
3389 for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces)
3390 {
3391 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3392
3393 for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3394 {
3395 /* Skip separate debug object, it's handled in the loop below. */
3396 if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink != nullptr)
3397 continue;
3398
3399 /* Try a probe kind breakpoint on main objfile. */
3400 if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (obj))
3401 continue;
3402
3403 /* Try longjmp_names kind breakpoints on main and separate_debug
3404 objfiles. */
3405 for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ())
3406 if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (debug_objfile))
3407 break;
3408 }
3409 }
3410 }
3411
3412 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3413 static void
3414 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3415 {
3416 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3417
3418 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3419
3420 for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces)
3421 {
3422 CORE_ADDR addr;
3423
3424 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3425
3426 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3427 {
3428 struct breakpoint *b;
3429 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3430 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3431
3432 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3433
3434 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3435 continue;
3436
3437 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3438 {
3439 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3440
3441 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3442 if (m.minsym == NULL || (m.minsym->type () != mst_text
3443 && m.minsym->type () != mst_file_text))
3444 {
3445 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3446 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3447 continue;
3448 }
3449 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3450 }
3451
3452 addr = bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.value_address ();
3453 b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr,
3454 bp_std_terminate_master,
3455 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3456 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3457 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3458 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3459 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3460 }
3461 }
3462 }
3463
3464 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using a
3465 probe. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3466
3467 static bool
3468 create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile)
3469 {
3470 struct breakpoint *b;
3471 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3472 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3473
3474 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3475
3476 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3477 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3478 {
3479 std::vector<probe *> ret
3480 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3481
3482 if (!ret.empty ())
3483 {
3484 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3485 probe *p = ret[0];
3486
3487 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3488 {
3489 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3490 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3491 ret.clear ();
3492 }
3493 }
3494 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3495 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3496 }
3497
3498 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3499 return false;
3500
3501 gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3502
3503 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3504 {
3505 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3506 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3507 bp_exception_master,
3508 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3509 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3510 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3511 }
3512
3513 return true;
3514 }
3515
3516 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using
3517 _Unwind_DebugHook. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3518
3519 static bool
3520 create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (objfile *objfile)
3521 {
3522 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3523 struct breakpoint *b;
3524 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3525 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3526 CORE_ADDR addr;
3527 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3528
3529 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3530
3531 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3532 return false;
3533
3534 gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3535
3536 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3537 {
3538 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3539
3540 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3541 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3542 {
3543 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3544 return false;
3545 }
3546
3547 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3548 }
3549
3550 addr = bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.value_address ();
3551 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr
3552 (gdbarch, addr, current_inferior ()->top_target ());
3553 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3554 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3555 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3556 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3557 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3558 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3559
3560 return true;
3561 }
3562
3563 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3564
3565 static void
3566 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3567 {
3568 for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3569 {
3570 /* Skip separate debug object. */
3571 if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink)
3572 continue;
3573
3574 /* Try a probe kind breakpoint. */
3575 if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (obj))
3576 continue;
3577
3578 /* Iterate over main and separate debug objects and try an
3579 _Unwind_DebugHook kind breakpoint. */
3580 for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ())
3581 if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (debug_objfile))
3582 break;
3583 }
3584 }
3585
3586 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3587
3588 static int
3589 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3590 {
3591 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3592 }
3593
3594 void
3595 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3596 {
3597 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3598 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3599 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3600 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3601 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3602 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3603 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3604 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3605 for (bp_location *bploc : all_bp_locations ())
3606 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3607 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3608
3609 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3610 {
3611 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3612 continue;
3613
3614 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3615 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3616 {
3617 delete_breakpoint (b);
3618 continue;
3619 }
3620
3621 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3622 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3623 {
3624 delete_breakpoint (b);
3625 continue;
3626 }
3627
3628 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3629 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3630 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3631 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3632 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3633 {
3634 delete_breakpoint (b);
3635 continue;
3636 }
3637
3638 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3639 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3640 {
3641 delete_breakpoint (b);
3642 continue;
3643 }
3644
3645 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3646 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3647 {
3648 delete_breakpoint (b);
3649 continue;
3650 }
3651
3652 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3653 after an exec. */
3654 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3655 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3656 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3657 {
3658 delete_breakpoint (b);
3659 continue;
3660 }
3661
3662 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3663 {
3664 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3665 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3666 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3667 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3668 continue;
3669 }
3670
3671 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3672 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3673 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3674 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3675 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3676 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3677
3678 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3679 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3680 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3681 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3682 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3683 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3684 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3685
3686 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3687 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3688 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3689 let finish_command delete it.
3690
3691 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3692 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3693 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3694 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3695 solib breakpoints.) */
3696
3697 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3698 {
3699 continue;
3700 }
3701
3702 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3703 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3704 a.out. */
3705 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3706 {
3707 delete_breakpoint (b);
3708 continue;
3709 }
3710 }
3711 }
3712
3713 int
3714 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3715 {
3716 int val = 0;
3717 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3718 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3719
3720 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3721 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3722
3723 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3724 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3725 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3726 {
3727 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3728 continue;
3729
3730 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3731 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3732 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3733 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3734 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3735 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3736 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3737 continue;
3738
3739 if (bl->inserted)
3740 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3741 }
3742
3743 return val;
3744 }
3745
3746 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3747 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3748 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3749 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3750 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3751
3752 static int
3753 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3754 {
3755 int val;
3756
3757 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3758 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3759
3760 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3761 This should not ever happen. */
3762 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3763
3764 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3765 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3766 {
3767 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3768 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3769 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3770
3771 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3772 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3773 || bl->section == NULL
3774 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3775 {
3776 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3777
3778 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3779 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3780 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3781 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3782 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3783 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3784 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3785 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3786 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3787 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3788 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3789 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3790 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3791 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3792 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3793 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3794 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3795 they should always be removed. */
3796 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3797 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3798 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3799 val = 0;
3800 else
3801 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3802 }
3803 else
3804 {
3805 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3806 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3807 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3808 {
3809 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3810 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3811 */
3812 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3813 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3814 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3815 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3816 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3817 else
3818 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3819 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3820 reason);
3821 }
3822 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3823 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3824 if (bl->inserted)
3825 {
3826 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3827 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3828 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3829 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3830
3831 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3832 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3833 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3834 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3835 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3836 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3837 else
3838 val = 0;
3839 }
3840 else
3841 {
3842 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3843 val = 0;
3844 }
3845 }
3846
3847 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3848 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3849 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3850 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3851 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3852 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3853 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3854 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3855 always-inserted mode. */
3856 if (val
3857 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3858 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3859 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3860 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3861 bl->address))))
3862 val = 0;
3863
3864 if (val)
3865 return val;
3866 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3867 }
3868 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3869 {
3870 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3871 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3872
3873 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3874 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3875
3876 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3877 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3878 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3879 bl->owner->number);
3880 }
3881 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3882 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3883 && !bl->duplicate)
3884 {
3885 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3886 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3887
3888 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3889 if (val)
3890 return val;
3891
3892 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3893 }
3894
3895 return 0;
3896 }
3897
3898 static int
3899 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3900 {
3901 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3902 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3903
3904 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3905 This should not ever happen. */
3906 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3907
3908 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3909
3910 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3911
3912 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3913 }
3914
3915 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3916
3917 void
3918 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3919 {
3920 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3921 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3922 bl->inserted = 0;
3923 }
3924
3925 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3926 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3927
3928 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3929 between runs.
3930
3931 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3932 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3933 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3934
3935
3936
3937 void
3938 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3939 {
3940 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3941
3942 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3943 nothing to do. */
3944 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3945 return;
3946
3947 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3948
3949 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3950 {
3951 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3952 continue;
3953
3954 switch (b->type)
3955 {
3956 case bp_call_dummy:
3957 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3958
3959 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3960 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3961 rid of it. */
3962
3963 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3964
3965 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3966
3967 case bp_shlib_event:
3968
3969 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3970 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3971 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3972 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3973 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3974
3975 (gdb) file prog-linux
3976 (gdb) run # native linux target
3977 ...
3978 (gdb) kill
3979 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3980 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3981 */
3982
3983 case bp_step_resume:
3984
3985 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3986
3987 case bp_single_step:
3988
3989 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3990
3991 delete_breakpoint (b);
3992 break;
3993
3994 case bp_watchpoint:
3995 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3996 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3997 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3998 {
3999 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4000
4001 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4002 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4003 delete_breakpoint (b);
4004 else
4005 {
4006 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
4007 valid. New ones will be created in
4008 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
4009 The next update_global_location_list call will
4010 garbage collect them. */
4011 b->loc = NULL;
4012
4013 if (context == inf_starting)
4014 {
4015 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4016 insert_breakpoints. */
4017 w->val.reset (nullptr);
4018 w->val_valid = false;
4019 }
4020 }
4021 }
4022 break;
4023 default:
4024 break;
4025 }
4026 }
4027
4028 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4029 for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
4030 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4031 moribund_locations.clear ();
4032 }
4033
4034 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4035 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4036 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4037 match, not program space. */
4038
4039 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4040 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4041 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4042 permanent breakpoint.
4043 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4044 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4045 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4046 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4047 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4048
4049 enum breakpoint_here
4050 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4051 {
4052 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4053
4054 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
4055 {
4056 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4057 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4058 continue;
4059
4060 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4061 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4062 || bl->permanent)
4063 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4064 {
4065 if (overlay_debugging
4066 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4067 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4068 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4069 else if (bl->permanent)
4070 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4071 else
4072 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4073 }
4074 }
4075
4076 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4077 }
4078
4079 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4080
4081 int
4082 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4083 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4084 {
4085 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
4086 {
4087 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4088 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4089 continue;
4090
4091 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4092 || bl->permanent)
4093 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4094 addr, len))
4095 {
4096 if (overlay_debugging
4097 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4098 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4099 {
4100 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4101 continue;
4102 }
4103
4104 return 1;
4105 }
4106 }
4107
4108 return 0;
4109 }
4110
4111 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4112
4113 int
4114 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4115 {
4116 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
4117 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4118 return 1;
4119
4120 return 0;
4121 }
4122
4123 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4124 ASPACE. */
4125
4126 static int
4127 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4128 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4129 {
4130 if (bl->inserted
4131 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4132 aspace, pc))
4133 {
4134 if (overlay_debugging
4135 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4136 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4137 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4138 else
4139 return 1;
4140 }
4141 return 0;
4142 }
4143
4144 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4145
4146 int
4147 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4148 {
4149 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4150 {
4151 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4152 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4153 continue;
4154
4155 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4156 return 1;
4157 }
4158 return 0;
4159 }
4160
4161 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4162 inserted at PC. */
4163
4164 int
4165 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4166 CORE_ADDR pc)
4167 {
4168 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4169 {
4170 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4171 continue;
4172
4173 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4174 return 1;
4175 }
4176
4177 return 0;
4178 }
4179
4180 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4181
4182 int
4183 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4184 CORE_ADDR pc)
4185 {
4186 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4187 {
4188 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4189 continue;
4190
4191 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4192 return 1;
4193 }
4194
4195 return 0;
4196 }
4197
4198 int
4199 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4200 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4201 {
4202 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
4203 {
4204 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4205 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4206 continue;
4207
4208 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4209 continue;
4210
4211 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
4212 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4213 {
4214 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4215
4216 /* Check for intersection. */
4217 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4218 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4219 if (l < h)
4220 return 1;
4221 }
4222 }
4223 return 0;
4224 }
4225
4226 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4227
4228 bool
4229 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
4230 {
4231 return (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
4232 }
4233
4234 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4235 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4236
4237 void
4238 bpstat_clear (bpstat **bsp)
4239 {
4240 bpstat *p;
4241 bpstat *q;
4242
4243 if (bsp == 0)
4244 return;
4245 p = *bsp;
4246 while (p != NULL)
4247 {
4248 q = p->next;
4249 delete p;
4250 p = q;
4251 }
4252 *bsp = NULL;
4253 }
4254
4255 bpstat::bpstat (const bpstat &other)
4256 : next (NULL),
4257 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4258 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4259 commands (other.commands),
4260 print (other.print),
4261 stop (other.stop),
4262 print_it (other.print_it)
4263 {
4264 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4265 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4266 }
4267
4268 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4269 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4270
4271 bpstat *
4272 bpstat_copy (bpstat *bs)
4273 {
4274 bpstat *p = nullptr;
4275 bpstat *tmp;
4276 bpstat *retval = nullptr;
4277
4278 if (bs == NULL)
4279 return bs;
4280
4281 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4282 {
4283 tmp = new bpstat (*bs);
4284
4285 if (p == NULL)
4286 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4287 retval = tmp;
4288 else
4289 p->next = tmp;
4290 p = tmp;
4291 }
4292 p->next = NULL;
4293 return retval;
4294 }
4295
4296 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4297
4298 bpstat *
4299 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat *bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4300 {
4301 if (bsp == NULL)
4302 return NULL;
4303
4304 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4305 {
4306 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4307 return bsp;
4308 }
4309 return NULL;
4310 }
4311
4312 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4313
4314 bool
4315 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat *bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4316 {
4317 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4318 {
4319 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4320 {
4321 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4322 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4323 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4324 return true;
4325 }
4326 else
4327 {
4328 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4329 sig))
4330 return true;
4331 }
4332 }
4333
4334 return false;
4335 }
4336
4337 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4338 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4339 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4340 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4341
4342 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4343 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4344 we set it.
4345 Return 1 otherwise. */
4346
4347 int
4348 bpstat_num (bpstat **bsp, int *num)
4349 {
4350 struct breakpoint *b;
4351
4352 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4353 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4354
4355 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4356 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4357 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4358 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4359 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4360 if (b == NULL)
4361 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4362
4363 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4364 return 1;
4365 }
4366
4367 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4368
4369 void
4370 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4371 {
4372 bpstat *bs;
4373
4374 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4375 return;
4376
4377 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4378 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4379 {
4380 bs->commands = NULL;
4381 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4382 }
4383 }
4384
4385 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4386
4387 static void
4388 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4389 {
4390 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4391 {
4392 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4393
4394 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4395 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4396 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4397 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4398 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4399 return;
4400 }
4401
4402 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4403 }
4404
4405 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4406 or its equivalent. */
4407
4408 static int
4409 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4410 {
4411 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4412 }
4413
4414 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4415 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4416 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4417 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4418
4419 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4420 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4421 bpstat of the current thread. */
4422
4423 static int
4424 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat **bsp)
4425 {
4426 bpstat *bs;
4427 int again = 0;
4428
4429 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4430 in bs->commands. */
4431 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4432 return 0;
4433
4434 scoped_restore save_executing
4435 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4436
4437 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4438
4439 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4440 bs = *bsp;
4441
4442 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4443 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4444 {
4445 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4446
4447 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4448
4449 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4450 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4451 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4452 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4453 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4454 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4455 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4456 the tree when we're done. */
4457 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4458 bs->commands = NULL;
4459 if (ccmd != NULL)
4460 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4461 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4462 {
4463 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4464 cmd = cmd->next;
4465 }
4466
4467 while (cmd != NULL)
4468 {
4469 execute_control_command (cmd);
4470
4471 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4472 break;
4473 else
4474 cmd = cmd->next;
4475 }
4476
4477 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4478 {
4479 if (current_ui->async)
4480 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4481 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4482 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4483 ;
4484 else
4485 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4486 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4487 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4488 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4489 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4490 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4491 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4492 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4493 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4494 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4495 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4496 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4497 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4498 again = 1;
4499 break;
4500 }
4501 }
4502 return again;
4503 }
4504
4505 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4506 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4507
4508 static thread_info *
4509 get_bpstat_thread ()
4510 {
4511 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())
4512 return NULL;
4513
4514 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4515 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing ())
4516 return NULL;
4517 return tp;
4518 }
4519
4520 void
4521 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4522 {
4523 auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions);
4524 thread_info *tp;
4525
4526 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4527 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4528 {
4529 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4530 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4531 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4532 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4533 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4534 break;
4535 }
4536
4537 cleanup_if_error.release ();
4538 }
4539
4540 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4541
4542 static void
4543 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4544 {
4545 if (val == NULL)
4546 fprintf_styled (stream, metadata_style.style (), _("<unreadable>"));
4547 else
4548 {
4549 struct value_print_options opts;
4550 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4551 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4552 }
4553 }
4554
4555 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4556 debugging multiple threads. */
4557
4558 void
4559 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4560 {
4561 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4562 return;
4563
4564 uiout->text ("\n");
4565
4566 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4567 {
4568 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4569
4570 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4571 uiout->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr));
4572
4573 const char *name = thread_name (thr);
4574 if (name != NULL)
4575 {
4576 uiout->text (" \"");
4577 uiout->field_string ("name", name);
4578 uiout->text ("\"");
4579 }
4580
4581 uiout->text (" hit ");
4582 }
4583 }
4584
4585 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4586 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4587 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4588 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4589 normal_stop(). */
4590
4591 static enum print_stop_action
4592 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat *bs)
4593 {
4594 switch (bs->print_it)
4595 {
4596 case print_it_noop:
4597 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4598 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4599 break;
4600
4601 case print_it_done:
4602 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4603 relevant messages. */
4604 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4605 break;
4606
4607 case print_it_normal:
4608 {
4609 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4610
4611 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4612 which has since been deleted. */
4613 if (b == NULL)
4614 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4615
4616 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4617 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4618 }
4619 break;
4620
4621 default:
4622 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4623 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4624 break;
4625 }
4626 }
4627
4628 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4629
4630 static void
4631 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4632 {
4633 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4634 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4635
4636 if (!is_catchpoint)
4637 {
4638 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4639 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4640 else
4641 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4642 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4643 }
4644
4645 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4646 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4647 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4648
4649 if (any_deleted)
4650 {
4651 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4652 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4653 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4654 {
4655 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4656
4657 if (ix > 0)
4658 current_uiout->text (" ");
4659 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4660 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4661 }
4662 }
4663
4664 if (any_added)
4665 {
4666 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4667 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4668 bool first = true;
4669 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4670 {
4671 if (!first)
4672 current_uiout->text (" ");
4673 first = false;
4674 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4675 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4676 }
4677 }
4678 }
4679
4680 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4681 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4682 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4683 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4684 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4685 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4686 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4687 routine is one of:
4688
4689 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4690 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4691 code to print the location. An example is
4692 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4693 the location.
4694 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4695 to also print the location part of the message.
4696 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4697 don't require a location appended to the end.
4698 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4699 further info to be printed. */
4700
4701 enum print_stop_action
4702 bpstat_print (bpstat *bs, int kind)
4703 {
4704 enum print_stop_action val;
4705
4706 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4707 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4708 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4709 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4710 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4711 {
4712 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4713 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4714 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4715 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4716 return val;
4717 }
4718
4719 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4720 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4721 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4722 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4723 {
4724 print_solib_event (0);
4725 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4726 }
4727
4728 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4729 with and nothing was printed. */
4730 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4731 }
4732
4733 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4734
4735 static bool
4736 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4737 {
4738 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4739 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4740
4741 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4742 return res;
4743 }
4744
4745 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4746
4747 bpstat::bpstat (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat ***bs_link_pointer)
4748 : next (NULL),
4749 bp_location_at (bp_location_ref_ptr::new_reference (bl)),
4750 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4751 commands (NULL),
4752 print (0),
4753 stop (0),
4754 print_it (print_it_normal)
4755 {
4756 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4757 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4758 }
4759
4760 bpstat::bpstat ()
4761 : next (NULL),
4762 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4763 commands (NULL),
4764 print (0),
4765 stop (0),
4766 print_it (print_it_normal)
4767 {
4768 }
4769 \f
4770 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4771 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4772
4773 int
4774 watchpoints_triggered (const target_waitstatus &ws)
4775 {
4776 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4777 CORE_ADDR addr;
4778
4779 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4780 {
4781 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4782 as not triggered. */
4783 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4784 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4785 {
4786 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4787
4788 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4789 }
4790
4791 return 0;
4792 }
4793
4794 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_inferior ()->top_target (), &addr))
4795 {
4796 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4797 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4798 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4799 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4800 {
4801 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4802
4803 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4804 }
4805
4806 return 1;
4807 }
4808
4809 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4810 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4811 triggered. */
4812
4813 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4814 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4815 {
4816 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4817
4818 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4819 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
4820 {
4821 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4822 {
4823 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4824 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4825
4826 if (newaddr == start)
4827 {
4828 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4829 break;
4830 }
4831 }
4832 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4833 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range
4834 (current_inferior ()->top_target (), addr, loc->address,
4835 loc->length))
4836 {
4837 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4838 break;
4839 }
4840 }
4841 }
4842
4843 return 1;
4844 }
4845
4846 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4847 enum wp_check_result
4848 {
4849 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4850 WP_DELETED = 1,
4851
4852 /* The value has changed. */
4853 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4854
4855 /* The value has not changed. */
4856 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4857
4858 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4859 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4860 };
4861
4862 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4863 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4864
4865 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4866 changed. */
4867
4868 static wp_check_result
4869 watchpoint_check (bpstat *bs)
4870 {
4871 struct watchpoint *b;
4872 struct frame_info *fr;
4873 int within_current_scope;
4874
4875 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4876 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4877 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4878
4879 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4880 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4881 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4882 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4883 return WP_IGNORE;
4884
4885 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4886 within_current_scope = 1;
4887 else
4888 {
4889 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4890 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4891 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4892
4893 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4894 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4895 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4896 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4897 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4898 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4899 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4900 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4901 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4902 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4903 return WP_IGNORE;
4904
4905 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4906 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4907
4908 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4909 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4910 if (within_current_scope)
4911 {
4912 struct symbol *function;
4913
4914 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4915 if (function == NULL
4916 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block, function->value_block ()))
4917 within_current_scope = 0;
4918 }
4919
4920 if (within_current_scope)
4921 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4922 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4923 the user. */
4924 select_frame (fr);
4925 }
4926
4927 if (within_current_scope)
4928 {
4929 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4930 time before we return to the command level and call
4931 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4932 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4933
4934 struct value *mark;
4935 struct value *new_val;
4936
4937 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4938 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4939 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4940 a mask watchpoint. */
4941 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4942
4943 mark = value_mark ();
4944 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &new_val,
4945 NULL, NULL, false);
4946
4947 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4948 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4949
4950 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4951 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4952 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4953 not what we want. */
4954 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4955 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4956 new_val)))
4957 {
4958 bs->old_val = b->val;
4959 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4960 b->val_valid = true;
4961 if (new_val != NULL)
4962 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4963 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4964 }
4965 else
4966 {
4967 /* Nothing changed. */
4968 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4969 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4970 }
4971 }
4972 else
4973 {
4974 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4975 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4976 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4977 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4978 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4979 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4980 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4981 the first value assigned). */
4982 /* We print all the stop information in
4983 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4984 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4985 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4986 here. */
4987
4988 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4989 {
4990 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4991
4992 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4993 uiout->field_string
4994 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4995 uiout->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has "
4996 "left the block in\n"
4997 "which its expression is valid.\n",
4998 signed_field ("wpnum", b->number));
4999 }
5000
5001 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5002 b->commands = NULL;
5003 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5004
5005 return WP_DELETED;
5006 }
5007 }
5008
5009 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5010 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5011 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5012
5013 static int
5014 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5015 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5016 const target_waitstatus &ws)
5017 {
5018 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5019
5020 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5021 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5022
5023 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5024 }
5025
5026 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5027 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5028
5029 static void
5030 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat *bs)
5031 {
5032 const struct bp_location *bl;
5033 struct watchpoint *b;
5034
5035 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5036 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
5037 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5038 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5039 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5040
5041 {
5042 int must_check_value = 0;
5043
5044 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5045 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5046 watched value. */
5047 must_check_value = 1;
5048 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5049 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5050 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5051 this watchpoint. */
5052 must_check_value = 1;
5053 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5054 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5055 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5056 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5057 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5058 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5059 must_check_value = 1;
5060
5061 if (must_check_value)
5062 {
5063 wp_check_result e;
5064
5065 try
5066 {
5067 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5068 }
5069 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5070 {
5071 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5072 "Error evaluating expression "
5073 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5074 b->number);
5075
5076 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5077 {
5078 gdb_printf (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5079 b->number);
5080 }
5081 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5082 e = WP_DELETED;
5083 }
5084
5085 switch (e)
5086 {
5087 case WP_DELETED:
5088 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5089 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5090 /* Stop. */
5091 break;
5092 case WP_IGNORE:
5093 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5094 bs->stop = 0;
5095 break;
5096 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5097 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5098 {
5099 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5100
5101 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5102 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5103 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5104 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5105 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5106 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5107 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5108 old value.
5109
5110 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5111 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5112 happen:
5113
5114 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5115 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5116 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5117 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5118
5119 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5120 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5121 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5122 watchpoint.
5123
5124 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5125 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5126 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5127 changes. This still gives false positives when
5128 the program writes the same value to memory as
5129 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5130 it for a read), but it's much better than
5131 nothing. */
5132
5133 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5134
5135 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5136 {
5137 for (breakpoint *other_b : all_breakpoints ())
5138 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5139 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5140 {
5141 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5142 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5143
5144 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5145 == watch_triggered_yes)
5146 {
5147 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5148 break;
5149 }
5150 }
5151 }
5152
5153 if (other_write_watchpoint
5154 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5155 {
5156 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5157 and the value changed since the last time we
5158 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5159 Ignore it. */
5160 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5161 bs->stop = 0;
5162 }
5163 }
5164 break;
5165 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5166 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5167 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5168 {
5169 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5170 the value hasn't changed. */
5171 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5172 bs->stop = 0;
5173 }
5174 /* Stop. */
5175 break;
5176 default:
5177 /* Can't happen. */
5178 break;
5179 }
5180 }
5181 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5182 {
5183 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5184 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5185 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5186 anything for this watchpoint. */
5187 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5188 bs->stop = 0;
5189 }
5190 }
5191 }
5192
5193 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5194 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5195 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5196 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5197
5198 static void
5199 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat *bs, thread_info *thread)
5200 {
5201 const struct bp_location *bl;
5202 struct breakpoint *b;
5203 /* Assume stop. */
5204 bool condition_result = true;
5205 struct expression *cond;
5206
5207 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5208
5209 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5210 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
5211 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5212 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5213 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5214
5215 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5216 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5217 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5218
5219 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5220 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5221 {
5222 bs->stop = 0;
5223 return;
5224 }
5225
5226 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5227 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5228 thread/task. */
5229 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5230 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5231 {
5232 bs->stop = 0;
5233 return;
5234 }
5235
5236 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5237 implemented. */
5238 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5239
5240 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5241 {
5242 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5243
5244 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5245 }
5246 else
5247 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5248
5249 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5250 {
5251 int within_current_scope = 1;
5252 struct watchpoint * w;
5253
5254 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5255 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5256 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5257 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5258 function call. */
5259 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5260
5261 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5262 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5263 else
5264 w = NULL;
5265
5266 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5267 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5268 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5269 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5270 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5271 call site. */
5272 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5273 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5274 else
5275 {
5276 struct frame_info *frame;
5277
5278 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5279 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5280 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5281 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5282 really matter which instantiation of the function
5283 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5284 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5285 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5286 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5287 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5288 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5289 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5290 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5291 intuitive. */
5292 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5293 if (frame != NULL)
5294 select_frame (frame);
5295 else
5296 within_current_scope = 0;
5297 }
5298 if (within_current_scope)
5299 {
5300 try
5301 {
5302 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5303 }
5304 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5305 {
5306 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5307 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5308 }
5309 }
5310 else
5311 {
5312 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5313 "in the current scope"));
5314 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5315 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5316 }
5317 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5318 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5319 }
5320
5321 if (cond && !condition_result)
5322 {
5323 bs->stop = 0;
5324 }
5325 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5326 {
5327 b->ignore_count--;
5328 bs->stop = 0;
5329 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5330 ++(b->hit_count);
5331 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5332 }
5333 }
5334
5335 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5336 on the current target. */
5337
5338 static int
5339 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5340 {
5341 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5342 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5343 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5344 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5345 }
5346
5347 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5348
5349 bpstat *
5350 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5351 const target_waitstatus &ws)
5352 {
5353 bpstat *bs_head = nullptr, **bs_link = &bs_head;
5354
5355 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
5356 {
5357 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5358 continue;
5359
5360 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
5361 {
5362 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5363 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5364 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5365 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5366 checked all locations already. */
5367 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5368 break;
5369
5370 if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond || bl->shlib_disabled)
5371 continue;
5372
5373 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5374 continue;
5375
5376 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5377 matches. */
5378
5379 bpstat *bs = new bpstat (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5380 explain stop. */
5381
5382 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5383 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5384 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5385 bs->stop = 1;
5386 bs->print = 1;
5387
5388 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5389 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5390 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5391 iteration. */
5392 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5393 {
5394 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5395
5396 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5397 }
5398 }
5399 }
5400
5401 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5402 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5403 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5404 {
5405 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
5406 {
5407 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5408 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5409 {
5410 bpstat *bs = new bpstat (loc, &bs_link);
5411 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5412 bs->stop = 0;
5413 bs->print = 0;
5414 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5415 }
5416 }
5417 }
5418
5419 return bs_head;
5420 }
5421
5422 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5423
5424 bpstat *
5425 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5426 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5427 const target_waitstatus &ws,
5428 bpstat *stop_chain)
5429 {
5430 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5431 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5432 bpstat *bs_head = stop_chain;
5433 bpstat *bs;
5434 int need_remove_insert;
5435 int removed_any;
5436
5437 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5438 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5439 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5440 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5441 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5442 inferior function calls. */
5443 if (bs_head == NULL)
5444 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5445
5446 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5447 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5448 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5449 "catch unload". */
5450 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5451 {
5452 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5453 {
5454 handle_solib_event ();
5455 break;
5456 }
5457 }
5458
5459 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5460 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5461 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5462
5463 removed_any = 0;
5464
5465 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5466 {
5467 if (!bs->stop)
5468 continue;
5469
5470 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5471 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5472 if (bs->stop)
5473 {
5474 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5475
5476 if (bs->stop)
5477 {
5478 ++(b->hit_count);
5479
5480 /* We will stop here. */
5481 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5482 {
5483 --(b->enable_count);
5484 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5485 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5486 removed_any = 1;
5487 }
5488 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5489 if (b->silent)
5490 bs->print = 0;
5491 bs->commands = b->commands;
5492 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5493 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5494 bs->print = 0;
5495
5496 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5497 }
5498
5499 }
5500
5501 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5502 print. */
5503 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5504 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5505 }
5506
5507 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5508 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5509 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5510 done later. */
5511 need_remove_insert = 0;
5512 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5513 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5514 if (!bs->stop
5515 && bs->breakpoint_at
5516 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5517 {
5518 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5519
5520 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5521 need_remove_insert = 1;
5522 }
5523
5524 if (need_remove_insert)
5525 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5526 else if (removed_any)
5527 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5528
5529 return bs_head;
5530 }
5531
5532 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5533
5534 bpstat *
5535 bpstat_stop_status_nowatch (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5536 thread_info *thread, const target_waitstatus &ws)
5537 {
5538 gdb_assert (!target_stopped_by_watchpoint ());
5539
5540 /* Clear all watchpoints' 'watchpoint_triggered' value from a
5541 previous stop to avoid confusing bpstat_stop_status. */
5542 watchpoints_triggered (ws);
5543
5544 return bpstat_stop_status (aspace, bp_addr, thread, ws);
5545 }
5546
5547 static void
5548 handle_jit_event (CORE_ADDR address)
5549 {
5550 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5551
5552 infrun_debug_printf ("handling bp_jit_event");
5553
5554 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5555 breakpoint_re_set. */
5556 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5557
5558 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (get_current_frame ());
5559 /* This event is caused by a breakpoint set in `jit_breakpoint_re_set`,
5560 thus it is expected that its objectfile can be found through
5561 minimal symbol lookup. If it doesn't work (and assert fails), it
5562 most likely means that `jit_breakpoint_re_set` was changes and this
5563 function needs to be updated too. */
5564 bound_minimal_symbol jit_bp_sym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (address);
5565 gdb_assert (jit_bp_sym.objfile != nullptr);
5566 jit_event_handler (gdbarch, jit_bp_sym.objfile);
5567
5568 target_terminal::inferior ();
5569 }
5570
5571 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5572
5573 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5574
5575 struct bpstat_what
5576 bpstat_what (bpstat *bs_head)
5577 {
5578 struct bpstat_what retval;
5579 bpstat *bs;
5580
5581 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5582 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5583 retval.is_longjmp = false;
5584
5585 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5586 {
5587 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5588 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5589 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5590 enum bptype bptype;
5591
5592 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5593 {
5594 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5595 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5596 bptype = bp_none;
5597 }
5598 else
5599 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5600
5601 switch (bptype)
5602 {
5603 case bp_none:
5604 break;
5605 case bp_breakpoint:
5606 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5607 case bp_single_step:
5608 case bp_until:
5609 case bp_finish:
5610 case bp_shlib_event:
5611 if (bs->stop)
5612 {
5613 if (bs->print)
5614 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5615 else
5616 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5617 }
5618 else
5619 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5620 break;
5621 case bp_watchpoint:
5622 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5623 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5624 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5625 if (bs->stop)
5626 {
5627 if (bs->print)
5628 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5629 else
5630 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5631 }
5632 else
5633 {
5634 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5635 This requires no further action. */
5636 }
5637 break;
5638 case bp_longjmp:
5639 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5640 case bp_exception:
5641 if (bs->stop)
5642 {
5643 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5644 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5645 }
5646 else
5647 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5648 break;
5649 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5650 case bp_exception_resume:
5651 if (bs->stop)
5652 {
5653 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5654 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5655 }
5656 else
5657 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5658 break;
5659 case bp_step_resume:
5660 if (bs->stop)
5661 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5662 else
5663 {
5664 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5665 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5666 }
5667 break;
5668 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5669 if (bs->stop)
5670 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5671 else
5672 {
5673 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5674 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5675 }
5676 break;
5677 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5678 case bp_thread_event:
5679 case bp_overlay_event:
5680 case bp_longjmp_master:
5681 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5682 case bp_exception_master:
5683 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5684 break;
5685 case bp_catchpoint:
5686 if (bs->stop)
5687 {
5688 if (bs->print)
5689 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5690 else
5691 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5692 }
5693 else
5694 {
5695 /* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints.
5696 For those, we need to step over the breakpoint. */
5697 if (bs->bp_location_at->loc_type != bp_loc_other)
5698 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5699 }
5700 break;
5701 case bp_jit_event:
5702 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5703 break;
5704 case bp_call_dummy:
5705 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5706 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5707 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5708 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5709 break;
5710 case bp_std_terminate:
5711 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5712 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5713 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5714 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5715 break;
5716 case bp_tracepoint:
5717 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5718 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5719 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5720 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5721 out already. */
5722 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5723 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5724 break;
5725 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5726 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5727 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5728 break;
5729 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5730 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5731 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5732 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5733 break;
5734
5735 case bp_dprintf:
5736 if (bs->stop)
5737 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5738 else
5739 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5740 break;
5741
5742 default:
5743 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5744 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5745 }
5746
5747 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5748 }
5749
5750 return retval;
5751 }
5752
5753 void
5754 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat *bs_head)
5755 {
5756 bpstat *bs;
5757
5758 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5759 {
5760 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5761
5762 if (b == NULL)
5763 continue;
5764 switch (b->type)
5765 {
5766 case bp_jit_event:
5767 handle_jit_event (bs->bp_location_at->address);
5768 break;
5769 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5770 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5771 break;
5772 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5773 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5774 break;
5775 }
5776 }
5777 }
5778
5779 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5780
5781 bool
5782 bpstat_should_step ()
5783 {
5784 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
5785 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5786 return true;
5787
5788 return false;
5789 }
5790
5791 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5792
5793 bool
5794 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat *bs)
5795 {
5796 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5797 if (bs->stop)
5798 return true;
5799
5800 return false;
5801 }
5802
5803 \f
5804
5805 /* Compute a number of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5806 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5807 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5808
5809 static int
5810 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5811 {
5812 int i, total_width, width, align;
5813 const char *text;
5814
5815 total_width = 0;
5816 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5817 {
5818 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5819 return total_width;
5820
5821 total_width += width + 1;
5822 }
5823
5824 return 0;
5825 }
5826
5827 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5828 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5829
5830 "host": Host evals condition.
5831 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5832 "target": Target evals condition.
5833 */
5834
5835 static const char *
5836 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5837 {
5838 char host_evals = 0;
5839 char target_evals = 0;
5840
5841 if (!b)
5842 return NULL;
5843
5844 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5845 return NULL;
5846
5847 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5848 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5849 return condition_evaluation_host;
5850
5851 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
5852 {
5853 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5854 target_evals++;
5855 else
5856 host_evals++;
5857 }
5858
5859 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5860 return condition_evaluation_both;
5861 else if (target_evals)
5862 return condition_evaluation_target;
5863 else
5864 return condition_evaluation_host;
5865 }
5866
5867 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5868 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5869
5870 static const char *
5871 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5872 {
5873 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5874 return NULL;
5875
5876 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5877 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5878 return condition_evaluation_host;
5879
5880 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5881 return condition_evaluation_target;
5882 else
5883 return condition_evaluation_host;
5884 }
5885
5886 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5887
5888 static void
5889 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5890 struct bp_location *loc)
5891 {
5892 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5893
5894 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5895
5896 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5897 loc = NULL;
5898
5899 if (loc != NULL)
5900 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5901
5902 if (b->display_canonical)
5903 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5904 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5905 {
5906 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5907
5908 if (sym)
5909 {
5910 uiout->text ("in ");
5911 uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
5912 function_name_style.style ());
5913 uiout->text (" ");
5914 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5915 uiout->text ("at ");
5916 }
5917 uiout->field_string ("file",
5918 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab),
5919 file_name_style.style ());
5920 uiout->text (":");
5921
5922 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5923 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5924
5925 uiout->field_signed ("line", loc->line_number);
5926 }
5927 else if (loc)
5928 {
5929 string_file stb;
5930
5931 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5932 demangle, "");
5933 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5934 }
5935 else
5936 {
5937 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5938 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5939 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5940 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5941 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5942 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5943 {
5944 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5945 uiout->text (",");
5946 else
5947 uiout->text (" ");
5948 uiout->text (b->extra_string.get ());
5949 }
5950 }
5951
5952 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5953 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5954 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5955 {
5956 uiout->text (" (");
5957 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5958 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5959 uiout->text (")");
5960 }
5961 }
5962
5963 static const char *
5964 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5965 {
5966 struct ep_type_description
5967 {
5968 enum bptype type;
5969 const char *description;
5970 };
5971 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5972 {
5973 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5974 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5975 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5976 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5977 {bp_until, "until"},
5978 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5979 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5980 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5981 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5982 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5983 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5984 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5985 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5986 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5987 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5988 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5989 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5990 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5991 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5992 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5993 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5994 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5995 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5996 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5997 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5998 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5999 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6000 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6001 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6002 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6003 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6004 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6005 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6006 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6007 };
6008
6009 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6010 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6011 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6012 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6013 (int) type);
6014
6015 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6016 }
6017
6018 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6019 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6020
6021 static void
6022 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6023 const char *field_name,
6024 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
6025 int mi_only)
6026 {
6027 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
6028
6029 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6030 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6031 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6032 return;
6033
6034 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
6035
6036 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
6037 {
6038 if (is_mi)
6039 {
6040 char mi_group[10];
6041
6042 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
6043 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
6044 }
6045 else
6046 {
6047 if (i == 0)
6048 uiout->text (" inf ");
6049 else
6050 uiout->text (", ");
6051
6052 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
6053 }
6054 }
6055 }
6056
6057 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations
6058 instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one. This makes "maint
6059 info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of
6060 catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation
6061 detail. */
6062
6063 static void
6064 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6065 struct bp_location *loc,
6066 int loc_number,
6067 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6068 int allflag, bool raw_loc)
6069 {
6070 struct command_line *l;
6071 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6072
6073 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6074 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6075 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6076 struct value_print_options opts;
6077
6078 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6079
6080 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6081 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6082 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6083 if (loc == NULL
6084 && (b->loc != NULL
6085 && (b->loc->next != NULL
6086 || !b->loc->enabled || b->loc->disabled_by_cond)))
6087 header_of_multiple = 1;
6088 if (loc == NULL)
6089 loc = b->loc;
6090
6091 annotate_record ();
6092
6093 /* 1 */
6094 annotate_field (0);
6095 if (part_of_multiple)
6096 uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6097 else
6098 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
6099
6100 /* 2 */
6101 annotate_field (1);
6102 if (part_of_multiple)
6103 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6104 else
6105 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6106
6107 /* 3 */
6108 annotate_field (2);
6109 if (part_of_multiple)
6110 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6111 else
6112 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6113
6114 /* 4 */
6115 annotate_field (3);
6116 /* For locations that are disabled because of an invalid condition,
6117 display "N*" on CLI, where "*" refers to a footnote below the
6118 table. For MI, simply display a "N" without a footnote. */
6119 const char *N = (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) ? "N" : "N*";
6120 if (part_of_multiple)
6121 uiout->field_string ("enabled", (loc->disabled_by_cond ? N
6122 : (loc->enabled ? "y" : "n")));
6123 else
6124 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6125
6126 /* 5 and 6 */
6127 if (!raw_loc && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6128 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6129 else
6130 {
6131 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6132 {
6133 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6134
6135 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6136 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6137 is relatively readable). */
6138 if (opts.addressprint)
6139 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6140 annotate_field (5);
6141 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string.get ());
6142 }
6143 else if (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
6144 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
6145 {
6146 if (opts.addressprint)
6147 {
6148 annotate_field (4);
6149 if (header_of_multiple)
6150 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>",
6151 metadata_style.style ());
6152 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6153 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>",
6154 metadata_style.style ());
6155 else
6156 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6157 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6158 }
6159 annotate_field (5);
6160 if (!header_of_multiple)
6161 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6162 if (b->loc)
6163 *last_loc = b->loc;
6164 }
6165 }
6166
6167 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6168 {
6169 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6170 int mi_only = 1;
6171
6172 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
6173 {
6174 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6175 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6176 }
6177
6178 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6179 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6180 if (allflag
6181 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6182 && (program_spaces.size () > 1
6183 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6184 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6185 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6186 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6187 mi_only = 0;
6188 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6189 }
6190
6191 if (!part_of_multiple)
6192 {
6193 if (b->thread != -1)
6194 {
6195 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6196 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6197 uiout->text (" thread ");
6198 uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
6199 }
6200 else if (b->task != 0)
6201 {
6202 uiout->text (" task ");
6203 uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task);
6204 }
6205 }
6206
6207 uiout->text ("\n");
6208
6209 if (!part_of_multiple)
6210 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6211
6212 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6213 {
6214 annotate_field (6);
6215 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6216 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6217 the frame ID. */
6218 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6219 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6220 uiout->text ("\n");
6221 }
6222
6223 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6224 {
6225 annotate_field (7);
6226 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6227 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6228 else
6229 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6230 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string.get ());
6231
6232 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6233 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6234 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6235 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6236 == condition_evaluation_target)
6237 {
6238 uiout->message (" (%pF evals)",
6239 string_field ("evaluated-by",
6240 bp_condition_evaluator (b)));
6241 }
6242 uiout->text ("\n");
6243 }
6244
6245 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6246 {
6247 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6248 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6249 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6250 uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
6251 else
6252 {
6253 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6254
6255 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6256 }
6257 uiout->text ("\n");
6258 }
6259
6260 if (!part_of_multiple)
6261 {
6262 if (b->hit_count)
6263 {
6264 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6265 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6266 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6267 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6268 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6269 else
6270 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6271 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6272 uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
6273 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6274 uiout->text (" time\n");
6275 else
6276 uiout->text (" times\n");
6277 }
6278 else
6279 {
6280 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6281 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6282 uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
6283 }
6284 }
6285
6286 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6287 {
6288 annotate_field (8);
6289 uiout->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n",
6290 signed_field ("ignore", b->ignore_count));
6291 }
6292
6293 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6294 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6295 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6296 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6297 {
6298 annotate_field (8);
6299 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6300 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6301 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6302 if (b->ignore_count)
6303 uiout->text ("additional ");
6304 else
6305 uiout->text ("next ");
6306 uiout->field_signed ("enable", b->enable_count);
6307 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6308 }
6309
6310 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6311 {
6312 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6313
6314 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6315 {
6316 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6317 uiout->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6318 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6319 }
6320 }
6321
6322 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6323 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6324 {
6325 annotate_field (9);
6326 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6327 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6328 }
6329
6330 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6331 {
6332 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6333
6334 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6335 {
6336 annotate_field (10);
6337 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6338 uiout->field_signed ("pass", t->pass_count);
6339 uiout->text (" \n");
6340 }
6341
6342 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6343 pending. */
6344 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6345 {
6346 annotate_field (11);
6347
6348 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6349 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6350 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6351 else
6352 {
6353 if (loc->inserted)
6354 uiout->text ("\t");
6355 else
6356 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6357 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6358 }
6359 }
6360 }
6361
6362 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6363 {
6364 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6365 {
6366 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6367
6368 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string.get ());
6369 }
6370 else if (b->location != NULL
6371 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6372 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6373 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6374 }
6375 }
6376
6377 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6378
6379 bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false;
6380
6381 static void
6382 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6383 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6384 int allflag)
6385 {
6386 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6387 bool use_fixed_output
6388 = (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output)
6389 || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally);
6390
6391 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (gdb::in_place, uiout, "bkpt");
6392 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag, false);
6393
6394 /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations
6395 are outside. */
6396 if (!use_fixed_output)
6397 bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset ();
6398
6399 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6400 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6401 locations, if any. */
6402 if (b->ops == NULL
6403 || b->ops->print_one == NULL
6404 || allflag)
6405 {
6406 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6407 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6408 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6409 situation.
6410
6411 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6412 internally, that's not a property exposed to users.
6413
6414 Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with
6415 breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property
6416 exposed to users. We do however display the internal
6417 breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints". */
6418 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6419 && (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
6420 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
6421 && (allflag
6422 || (b->loc && (b->loc->next
6423 || !b->loc->enabled
6424 || b->loc->disabled_by_cond))))
6425 {
6426 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list;
6427
6428 /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid
6429 MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a
6430 list. */
6431 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output)
6432 locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations");
6433
6434 int n = 1;
6435 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6436 {
6437 ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6438 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
6439 allflag, allflag);
6440 n++;
6441 }
6442 }
6443 }
6444 }
6445
6446 static int
6447 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6448 {
6449 int print_address_bits = 0;
6450
6451 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6452 address to print. */
6453 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6454 return 0;
6455
6456 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6457 {
6458 int addr_bit;
6459
6460 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6461 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6462 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6463 }
6464
6465 return print_address_bits;
6466 }
6467
6468 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6469
6470 void
6471 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6472 {
6473 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6474 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6475 }
6476
6477 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6478 internal or momentary. */
6479
6480 int
6481 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6482 {
6483 return b->number > 0;
6484 }
6485
6486 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6487
6488 int
6489 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6490 {
6491 return b->loc == NULL;
6492 }
6493
6494 /* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints).
6495
6496 If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as
6497 understood by number_or_range_parser. Only breakpoints included in this
6498 list are then printed.
6499
6500 If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints.
6501
6502 If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6503 ones for which it returns true.
6504
6505 Return the total number of breakpoints listed. */
6506
6507 static int
6508 breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list, bool show_internal,
6509 bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6510 {
6511 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6512 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6513 struct value_print_options opts;
6514 int print_address_bits = 0;
6515 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6516 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6517 bool has_disabled_by_cond_location = false;
6518
6519 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6520
6521 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6522 required for address fields. */
6523 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6524 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6525 {
6526 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6527 if (filter && !filter (b))
6528 continue;
6529
6530 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6531 accept. Skip the others. */
6532 if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
6533 {
6534 if (show_internal && parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
6535 continue;
6536 if (!show_internal && !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
6537 continue;
6538 }
6539
6540 if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6541 {
6542 int addr_bit, type_len;
6543
6544 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6545 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6546 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6547
6548 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6549 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6550 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6551
6552 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6553 }
6554 }
6555
6556 {
6557 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6558 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6559 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6560 "BreakpointTable");
6561
6562 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6563 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6564 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6565 annotate_field (0);
6566 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6567 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6568 annotate_field (1);
6569 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6570 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6571 annotate_field (2);
6572 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6573 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6574 annotate_field (3);
6575 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6576 if (opts.addressprint)
6577 {
6578 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6579 annotate_field (4);
6580 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6581 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6582 else
6583 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6584 }
6585 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6586 annotate_field (5);
6587 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6588 uiout->table_body ();
6589 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6590 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6591
6592 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6593 {
6594 QUIT;
6595 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6596 if (filter && !filter (b))
6597 continue;
6598
6599 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6600 accept. Skip the others. */
6601
6602 if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
6603 {
6604 if (show_internal) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6605 {
6606 if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
6607 continue;
6608 }
6609 else /* all others */
6610 {
6611 if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
6612 continue;
6613 }
6614 }
6615 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6616 show_internal is set. */
6617 if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6618 {
6619 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, show_internal);
6620 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6621 if (loc->disabled_by_cond)
6622 has_disabled_by_cond_location = true;
6623 }
6624 }
6625 }
6626
6627 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6628 {
6629 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6630 empty list. */
6631 if (!filter)
6632 {
6633 if (bp_num_list == NULL || *bp_num_list == '\0')
6634 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6635 else
6636 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6637 bp_num_list);
6638 }
6639 }
6640 else
6641 {
6642 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6643 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6644
6645 if (has_disabled_by_cond_location && !uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6646 uiout->message (_("(*): Breakpoint condition is invalid at this "
6647 "location.\n"));
6648 }
6649
6650 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6651 there have been breakpoints? */
6652 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6653
6654 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6655 }
6656
6657 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6658 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6659
6660 static void
6661 default_collect_info (void)
6662 {
6663 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6664
6665 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6666 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6667 not wanted. */
6668 if (default_collect.empty ())
6669 return;
6670
6671 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6672 actions. */
6673 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6674 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6675 uiout->text (" \n");
6676 }
6677
6678 static void
6679 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6680 {
6681 breakpoint_1 (args, false, NULL);
6682
6683 default_collect_info ();
6684 }
6685
6686 static void
6687 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6688 {
6689 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_watchpoint);
6690 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6691
6692 if (num_printed == 0)
6693 {
6694 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6695 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6696 else
6697 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6698 }
6699 }
6700
6701 static void
6702 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6703 {
6704 breakpoint_1 (args, true, NULL);
6705
6706 default_collect_info ();
6707 }
6708
6709 static int
6710 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6711 struct program_space *pspace,
6712 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6713 {
6714 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
6715 {
6716 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6717 && bl->address == pc
6718 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6719 return 1;
6720 }
6721 return 0;
6722 }
6723
6724 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6725 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6726 address spaces. */
6727
6728 static void
6729 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6730 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6731 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6732 {
6733 int others = 0;
6734
6735 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6736 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6737 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6738
6739 if (others > 0)
6740 {
6741 if (others == 1)
6742 gdb_printf (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6743 else /* if (others == ???) */
6744 gdb_printf (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6745 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6746 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6747 {
6748 others--;
6749 gdb_printf ("%d", b->number);
6750 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6751 gdb_printf (" (all threads)");
6752 else if (b->thread != -1)
6753 gdb_printf (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6754 gdb_printf ("%s%s ",
6755 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6756 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6757 ? " (disabled)"
6758 : ""),
6759 (others > 1) ? ","
6760 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6761 }
6762 current_uiout->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"),
6763 styled_string (address_style.style (),
6764 paddress (gdbarch, pc)));
6765 }
6766 }
6767 \f
6768
6769 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC.
6770 For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are
6771 irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to
6772 other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6773
6774 More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are
6775 not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location
6776 address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types
6777 to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address
6778 zero. */
6779
6780 static bool
6781 bl_address_is_meaningful (bp_location *loc)
6782 {
6783 return loc->loc_type != bp_loc_other;
6784 }
6785
6786 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6787 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6788
6789 static int
6790 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6791 struct bp_location *loc2)
6792 {
6793 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6794 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6795
6796 /* Both of them must exist. */
6797 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6798 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6799
6800 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6801 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6802 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6803 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6804 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6805 other watchpoint. */
6806 if ((w1->cond_exp
6807 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6808 loc1->length,
6809 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6810 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6811 || (w2->cond_exp
6812 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6813 loc2->length,
6814 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6815 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6816 return 0;
6817
6818 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6819 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6820 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6821 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6822 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6823 become hw_access locations later. */
6824 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6825 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6826 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6827 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6828 }
6829
6830 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6831
6832 int
6833 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6834 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6835 {
6836 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6837 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6838 && addr1 == addr2);
6839 }
6840
6841 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6842 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6843 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6844 space doesn't really matter. */
6845
6846 static int
6847 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6848 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6849 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6850 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6851 {
6852 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6853 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6854 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6855 }
6856
6857 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6858 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6859 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6860 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6861
6862 static int
6863 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6864 const address_space *aspace,
6865 CORE_ADDR addr)
6866 {
6867 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6868 aspace, addr)
6869 || (bl->length
6870 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6871 bl->address, bl->length,
6872 aspace, addr)));
6873 }
6874
6875 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6876 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6877 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6878 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6879 doesn't really matter. */
6880
6881 static int
6882 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6883 const address_space *aspace,
6884 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6885 {
6886 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6887 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6888 {
6889 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6890
6891 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6892 return 1;
6893 }
6894 return 0;
6895 }
6896
6897 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6898 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6899 true, otherwise returns false. */
6900
6901 static int
6902 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6903 struct bp_location *loc2)
6904 {
6905 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6906 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6907 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6908 different locations. */
6909 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6910 else
6911 return 0;
6912 }
6913
6914 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6915 (bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent
6916 the same location. If SW_HW_BPS_MATCH is true, then software
6917 breakpoint locations and hardware breakpoint locations match,
6918 otherwise they don't. */
6919
6920 static int
6921 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6922 struct bp_location *loc2,
6923 bool sw_hw_bps_match)
6924 {
6925 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6926
6927 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6928 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6929 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6930
6931 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6932 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6933
6934 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6935 return 0;
6936 else if (hw_point1)
6937 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6938 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6939 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6940 else
6941 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged
6942 breakpoints. Keep this in sync with
6943 bp_location_is_less_than. */
6944 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6945 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6946 && (loc1->loc_type == loc2->loc_type || sw_hw_bps_match)
6947 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6948 }
6949
6950 static void
6951 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6952 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6953 {
6954 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6955 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6956 char astr1[64];
6957 char astr2[64];
6958
6959 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6960 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6961 if (have_bnum)
6962 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6963 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6964 else
6965 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6966 }
6967
6968 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6969 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6970 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6971 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6972
6973 static CORE_ADDR
6974 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6975 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6976 {
6977 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6978 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6979 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6980 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6981 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6982 {
6983 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6984 have their addresses modified. */
6985 return bpaddr;
6986 }
6987 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6988 {
6989 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6990 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6991 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6992 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6993 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6994 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6995 return bpaddr;
6996 }
6997 else
6998 {
6999 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
7000
7001 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7002 {
7003 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7004 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7005 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7006 }
7007
7008 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
7009
7010 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7011 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7012 is required. */
7013 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7014 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7015
7016 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7017 }
7018 }
7019
7020 static bp_loc_type
7021 bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type)
7022 {
7023 switch (type)
7024 {
7025 case bp_breakpoint:
7026 case bp_single_step:
7027 case bp_until:
7028 case bp_finish:
7029 case bp_longjmp:
7030 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7031 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7032 case bp_exception:
7033 case bp_exception_resume:
7034 case bp_step_resume:
7035 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7036 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7037 case bp_call_dummy:
7038 case bp_std_terminate:
7039 case bp_shlib_event:
7040 case bp_thread_event:
7041 case bp_overlay_event:
7042 case bp_jit_event:
7043 case bp_longjmp_master:
7044 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7045 case bp_exception_master:
7046 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7047 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7048 case bp_dprintf:
7049 return bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7050 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7051 return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7052 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7053 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7054 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7055 return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7056 case bp_watchpoint:
7057 case bp_catchpoint:
7058 case bp_tracepoint:
7059 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7060 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7061 return bp_loc_other;
7062 default:
7063 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7064 }
7065 }
7066
7067 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner, bp_loc_type type)
7068 {
7069 this->owner = owner;
7070 this->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7071 this->shlib_disabled = 0;
7072 this->enabled = 1;
7073 this->disabled_by_cond = false;
7074
7075 this->loc_type = type;
7076
7077 if (this->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
7078 || this->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
7079 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this);
7080
7081 incref ();
7082 }
7083
7084 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner)
7085 : bp_location::bp_location (owner,
7086 bp_location_from_bp_type (owner->type))
7087 {
7088 }
7089
7090 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7091
7092 static struct bp_location *
7093 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7094 {
7095 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7096 }
7097
7098 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7099 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7100
7101 static void
7102 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7103 {
7104 bp_location_ref_policy::decref (*blp);
7105 *blp = NULL;
7106 }
7107
7108 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7109
7110 static breakpoint *
7111 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7112 {
7113 struct breakpoint *b1;
7114 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7115
7116 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7117 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7118
7119 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7120 if (b1 == 0)
7121 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7122 else
7123 {
7124 while (b1->next)
7125 b1 = b1->next;
7126 b1->next = b.release ();
7127 }
7128
7129 return result;
7130 }
7131
7132 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7133
7134 static void
7135 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7136 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7137 enum bptype bptype,
7138 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7139 {
7140 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7141
7142 b->ops = ops;
7143 b->type = bptype;
7144 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7145 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7146 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7147 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7148 }
7149
7150 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7151 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7152
7153 static struct breakpoint *
7154 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7155 enum bptype bptype,
7156 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7157 {
7158 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7159
7160 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7161 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7162 }
7163
7164 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
7165
7166 static void
7167 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
7168 {
7169 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7170
7171 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7172 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7173 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7174 {
7175 const char *function_name;
7176
7177 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7178 && (loc->msymbol->type () == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7179 || loc->msymbol->type () == mst_data_gnu_ifunc))
7180 {
7181 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7182
7183 function_name = loc->msymbol->linkage_name ();
7184
7185 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7186 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7187 {
7188 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7189 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7190 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7191 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7192 breakpoint. */
7193 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7194 }
7195 }
7196 else
7197 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7198
7199 if (function_name)
7200 loc->function_name = make_unique_xstrdup (function_name);
7201 }
7202 }
7203
7204 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7205 struct gdbarch *
7206 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7207 {
7208 if (sal.section)
7209 return sal.section->objfile->arch ();
7210 if (sal.symtab)
7211 return sal.symtab->compunit ()->objfile ()->arch ();
7212
7213 return NULL;
7214 }
7215
7216 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7217 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7218 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7219
7220 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7221 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7222 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7223
7224 static void
7225 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7226 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7227 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7228 {
7229 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7230
7231 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7232
7233 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7234 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7235
7236 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7237 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7238 program space. */
7239 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7240 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7241 }
7242
7243 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7244 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7245 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7246 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7247 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7248 is also returned as the value of this function.
7249
7250 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7251 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7252 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7253 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7254 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7255 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7256 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7257
7258 static struct breakpoint *
7259 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7260 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7261 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7262 {
7263 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7264
7265 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7266 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7267 }
7268
7269 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7270 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7271 initiated the operation. */
7272
7273 void
7274 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7275 {
7276 int thread = tp->global_num;
7277
7278 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7279 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7280 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7281 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7282 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7283 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7284 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7285 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7286 {
7287 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7288 struct breakpoint *clone;
7289
7290 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7291 after their removal. */
7292 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7293 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7294 clone->thread = thread;
7295 }
7296
7297 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7298 }
7299
7300 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7301 void
7302 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7303 {
7304 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7305 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7306 {
7307 if (b->thread == thread)
7308 delete_breakpoint (b);
7309 }
7310 }
7311
7312 void
7313 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7314 {
7315 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7316 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7317 {
7318 if (b->thread == thread)
7319 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7320 }
7321 }
7322
7323 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7324 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7325 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7326 breakpoints. */
7327
7328 struct breakpoint *
7329 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7330 {
7331 breakpoint *retval = nullptr;
7332
7333 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7334 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7335 {
7336 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7337
7338 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7339 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7340 1);
7341 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7342
7343 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7344
7345 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7346 if (retval == NULL)
7347 retval = new_b;
7348 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7349 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7350 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7351 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7352 }
7353
7354 return retval;
7355 }
7356
7357 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7358 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7359 stack.
7360
7361 If the unwind fails then there is not sufficient information to discard
7362 dummy frames. In this case, elide the clean up and the dummy frames will
7363 be cleaned up next time this function is called from a location where
7364 unwinding is possible. */
7365
7366 void
7367 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7368 {
7369 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7370
7371 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7372 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7373 {
7374 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7375
7376 /* Find the bp_call_dummy breakpoint in the list of breakpoints
7377 chained off b->related_breakpoint. */
7378 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7379 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7380
7381 /* If there was no bp_call_dummy breakpoint then there's nothing
7382 more to do. Or, if the dummy frame associated with the
7383 bp_call_dummy is still on the stack then we need to leave this
7384 bp_call_dummy in place. */
7385 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7386 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7387 continue;
7388
7389 /* We didn't find the dummy frame on the stack, this could be
7390 because we have longjmp'd to a stack frame that is previous to
7391 the dummy frame, or it could be because the stack unwind is
7392 broken at some point between the longjmp frame and the dummy
7393 frame.
7394
7395 Next we figure out why the stack unwind stopped. If it looks
7396 like the unwind is complete then we assume the dummy frame has
7397 been jumped over, however, if the unwind stopped for an
7398 unexpected reason then we assume the stack unwind is currently
7399 broken, and that we will (eventually) return to the dummy
7400 frame.
7401
7402 It might be tempting to consider using frame_id_inner here, but
7403 that is not safe. There is no guarantee that the stack frames
7404 we are looking at here are even on the same stack as the
7405 original dummy frame, hence frame_id_inner can't be used. See
7406 the comments on frame_id_inner for more details. */
7407 bool unwind_finished_unexpectedly = false;
7408 for (struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame (); fi != nullptr; )
7409 {
7410 struct frame_info *prev = get_prev_frame (fi);
7411 if (prev == nullptr)
7412 {
7413 /* FI is the last stack frame. Why did this frame not
7414 unwind further? */
7415 auto stop_reason = get_frame_unwind_stop_reason (fi);
7416 if (stop_reason != UNWIND_NO_REASON
7417 && stop_reason != UNWIND_OUTERMOST)
7418 unwind_finished_unexpectedly = true;
7419 }
7420 fi = prev;
7421 }
7422 if (unwind_finished_unexpectedly)
7423 continue;
7424
7425 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7426
7427 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7428 {
7429 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7430 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7431 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7432 }
7433 delete_breakpoint (b);
7434 }
7435 }
7436
7437 void
7438 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7439 {
7440 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7441 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7442 {
7443 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7444 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7445 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7446 }
7447 }
7448
7449 void
7450 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7451 {
7452 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7453 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7454 {
7455 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7456 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7457 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7458 }
7459 }
7460
7461 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7462 master breakpoint. */
7463 void
7464 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7465 {
7466 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7467 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7468 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7469 {
7470 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7471 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7472 }
7473 }
7474
7475 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7476 void
7477 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7478 {
7479 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7480 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7481 delete_breakpoint (b);
7482 }
7483
7484 struct breakpoint *
7485 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7486 {
7487 struct breakpoint *b;
7488
7489 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7490 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7491
7492 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7493 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7494 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7495
7496 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7497
7498 return b;
7499 }
7500
7501 struct lang_and_radix
7502 {
7503 enum language lang;
7504 int radix;
7505 };
7506
7507 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7508
7509 struct breakpoint *
7510 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7511 {
7512 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7513 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7514 }
7515
7516 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7517
7518 void
7519 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7520 {
7521 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7522 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7523 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7524 delete_breakpoint (b);
7525 }
7526
7527 void
7528 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7529 {
7530 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7531 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7532 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7533 delete_breakpoint (b);
7534 }
7535
7536 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7537
7538 void
7539 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7540 {
7541 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7542 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7543 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7544 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7545 }
7546
7547 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7548 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7549 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7550
7551 static struct breakpoint *
7552 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7553 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7554 {
7555 struct breakpoint *b;
7556
7557 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7558 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7559 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7560 return b;
7561 }
7562
7563 struct breakpoint *
7564 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7565 {
7566 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7567 }
7568
7569 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7570
7571 struct breakpoint *
7572 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7573 {
7574 struct breakpoint *b;
7575
7576 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7577 locations. */
7578 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7579 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7580 {
7581 delete_breakpoint (b);
7582 return NULL;
7583 }
7584 return b;
7585 }
7586
7587 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7588 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7589
7590 void
7591 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7592 {
7593 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
7594 {
7595 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7596 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7597
7598 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7599 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7600 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7601 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7602 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7603 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7604 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7605 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7606 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7607 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7608 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7609 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7610 )
7611 {
7612 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7613 }
7614 }
7615 }
7616
7617 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7618 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7619 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7620
7621 static void
7622 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7623 {
7624 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7625
7626 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
7627 {
7628 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7629 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7630
7631 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7632 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7633 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7634 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7635 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7636 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7637 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7638 || is_tracepoint (b))
7639 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7640 {
7641 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7642 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7643 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7644 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7645 loc->inserted = 0;
7646
7647 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7648 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7649
7650 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7651 {
7652 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7653 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7654 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7655 solib->so_name);
7656 }
7657 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7658 }
7659 }
7660 }
7661
7662 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7663 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7664 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7665
7666 static void
7667 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7668 {
7669 if (objfile == NULL)
7670 return;
7671
7672 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7673 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7674 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7675 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7676 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7677 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7678 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7679 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7680 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7681 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7682 main objfile). */
7683 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7684 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7685 return;
7686
7687 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7688 {
7689 int bp_modified = 0;
7690
7691 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7692 continue;
7693
7694 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
7695 {
7696 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7697
7698 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7699 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7700 continue;
7701
7702 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7703 continue;
7704
7705 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7706 continue;
7707
7708 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7709 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7710 continue;
7711
7712 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7713 {
7714 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7715 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7716 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7717 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7718 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7719 unmapped. */
7720
7721 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7722
7723 bp_modified = 1;
7724 }
7725 }
7726
7727 if (bp_modified)
7728 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7729 }
7730 }
7731
7732 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7733 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7734 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7735
7736 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7737 {
7738 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7739 bool is_load;
7740
7741 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7742 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7743 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> regex;
7744 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7745 };
7746
7747 static int
7748 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7749 {
7750 return 0;
7751 }
7752
7753 static int
7754 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7755 {
7756 return 0;
7757 }
7758
7759 static int
7760 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
7761 const address_space *aspace,
7762 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7763 const target_waitstatus &ws)
7764 {
7765 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7766
7767 if (ws.kind () == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
7768 return 1;
7769
7770 for (breakpoint *other : all_breakpoints ())
7771 {
7772 if (other == bl->owner)
7773 continue;
7774
7775 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
7776 continue;
7777
7778 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
7779 continue;
7780
7781 for (bp_location *other_bl : other->locations ())
7782 {
7783 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
7784 return 1;
7785 }
7786 }
7787
7788 return 0;
7789 }
7790
7791 static void
7792 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstat *bs)
7793 {
7794 struct solib_catchpoint *self
7795 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7796
7797 if (self->is_load)
7798 {
7799 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
7800 {
7801 if (!self->regex
7802 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7803 return;
7804 }
7805 }
7806 else
7807 {
7808 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
7809 {
7810 if (!self->regex
7811 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7812 return;
7813 }
7814 }
7815
7816 bs->stop = 0;
7817 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
7818 }
7819
7820 static enum print_stop_action
7821 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat *bs)
7822 {
7823 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7824 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7825
7826 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7827 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7828 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7829 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7830 else
7831 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7832 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
7833 uiout->text ("\n");
7834 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7835 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7836 print_solib_event (1);
7837 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7838 }
7839
7840 static void
7841 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
7842 {
7843 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
7844 struct value_print_options opts;
7845 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7846
7847 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7848 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7849 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7850 readable). */
7851 if (opts.addressprint)
7852 {
7853 annotate_field (4);
7854 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7855 }
7856
7857 std::string msg;
7858 annotate_field (5);
7859 if (self->is_load)
7860 {
7861 if (self->regex)
7862 msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"),
7863 self->regex.get ());
7864 else
7865 msg = _("load of library");
7866 }
7867 else
7868 {
7869 if (self->regex)
7870 msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"),
7871 self->regex.get ());
7872 else
7873 msg = _("unload of library");
7874 }
7875 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
7876
7877 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7878 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
7879 }
7880
7881 static void
7882 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
7883 {
7884 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
7885
7886 gdb_printf (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
7887 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
7888 }
7889
7890 static void
7891 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7892 {
7893 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
7894
7895 gdb_printf (fp, "%s %s",
7896 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
7897 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
7898 if (self->regex)
7899 gdb_printf (fp, " %s", self->regex.get ());
7900 gdb_printf (fp, "\n");
7901 }
7902
7903 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
7904
7905 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7906
7907 void
7908 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, bool is_load, bool is_temp, bool enabled)
7909 {
7910 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7911
7912 if (!arg)
7913 arg = "";
7914 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
7915
7916 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
7917
7918 if (*arg != '\0')
7919 {
7920 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
7921 _("Invalid regexp")));
7922 c->regex = make_unique_xstrdup (arg);
7923 }
7924
7925 c->is_load = is_load;
7926 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
7927 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
7928
7929 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7930
7931 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
7932 }
7933
7934 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
7935 "catch unload". */
7936
7937 static void
7938 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
7939 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7940 {
7941 const int enabled = 1;
7942 bool temp = command->context () == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7943
7944 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, temp, enabled);
7945 }
7946
7947 static void
7948 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
7949 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7950 {
7951 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
7952 }
7953
7954 static void
7955 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
7956 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7957 {
7958 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
7959 }
7960
7961 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7962
7963 void
7964 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
7965 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bool temp,
7966 const char *cond_string,
7967 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7968 {
7969 symtab_and_line sal;
7970 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
7971
7972 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
7973
7974 if (cond_string == nullptr)
7975 b->cond_string.reset ();
7976 else
7977 b->cond_string = make_unique_xstrdup (cond_string);
7978 b->disposition = temp ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7979 }
7980
7981 void
7982 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
7983 {
7984 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
7985 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
7986 if (is_tracepoint (b))
7987 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
7988 if (!internal)
7989 mention (b);
7990 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
7991
7992 if (update_gll)
7993 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7994 }
7995
7996 static int
7997 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
7998 {
7999 int i = 0;
8000
8001 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8002 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8003 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
8004 {
8005 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8006 one register. */
8007 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8008 }
8009
8010 return i;
8011 }
8012
8013 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8014 watchpoint. */
8015
8016 static int
8017 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8018 {
8019 int i = 0;
8020
8021 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8022 return 0;
8023
8024 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
8025 {
8026 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8027 one register. */
8028 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8029 }
8030
8031 return i;
8032 }
8033
8034 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8035 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8036 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8037 types _not_ TYPE. */
8038
8039 static int
8040 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8041 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8042 {
8043 int i = 0;
8044
8045 *other_type_used = 0;
8046 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8047 {
8048 if (b == except)
8049 continue;
8050 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8051 continue;
8052
8053 if (b->type == type)
8054 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8055 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8056 *other_type_used = 1;
8057 }
8058
8059 return i;
8060 }
8061
8062 void
8063 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8064 {
8065 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8066 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8067 {
8068 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8069 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8070 }
8071 }
8072
8073 void
8074 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8075 {
8076 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8077 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8078 {
8079 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8080 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8081 }
8082 }
8083
8084 void
8085 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8086 {
8087 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8088 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8089 }
8090
8091 void
8092 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8093 {
8094 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8095 breakpoint_re_set ();
8096 }
8097
8098 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8099 locations. */
8100
8101 static struct breakpoint *
8102 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8103 {
8104 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8105
8106 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8107 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8108
8109 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8110 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8111
8112 b->thread = thread;
8113 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8114
8115 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8116 }
8117
8118 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8119 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8120 frame. */
8121
8122 breakpoint_up
8123 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8124 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8125 {
8126 struct breakpoint *b;
8127
8128 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8129 tail-called one. */
8130 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8131
8132 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8133 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8134 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8135 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8136
8137 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8138
8139 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8140
8141 return breakpoint_up (b);
8142 }
8143
8144 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8145 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8146 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8147
8148 static struct breakpoint *
8149 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8150 enum bptype type,
8151 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8152 int loc_enabled)
8153 {
8154 struct breakpoint *copy;
8155
8156 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8157 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8158 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
8159
8160 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8161 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8162 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8163 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8164 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8165 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8166 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8167 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8168 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8169 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8170 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8171 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8172
8173 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8174 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8175 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8176
8177 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8178 return copy;
8179 }
8180
8181 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8182 ORIG is NULL. */
8183
8184 struct breakpoint *
8185 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8186 {
8187 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8188 if (orig == NULL)
8189 return NULL;
8190
8191 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8192 }
8193
8194 breakpoint_up
8195 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8196 enum bptype type)
8197 {
8198 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8199
8200 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8201 sal.pc = pc;
8202 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8203 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8204
8205 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8206 }
8207 \f
8208
8209 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8210
8211 static void
8212 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8213 {
8214 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8215 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8216 }
8217 \f
8218
8219 static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8220
8221 /* Handle "set breakpoint auto-hw on".
8222
8223 If the explicitly specified breakpoint type is not hardware
8224 breakpoint, check the memory map to see whether the breakpoint
8225 address is in read-only memory.
8226
8227 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory is read-only.
8228 We change the type of the location to hardware breakpoint.
8229
8230 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write. This
8231 means we've previously made the location hardware one, but then the
8232 memory map changed, so we undo.
8233 */
8234
8235 static void
8236 handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (bp_location *bl)
8237 {
8238 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints
8239 && bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
8240 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
8241 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint))
8242 {
8243 /* When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
8244 location types we've just set here, the only possible problem
8245 is that memory map has changed during running program, but
8246 it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
8247 mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address);
8248
8249 if (mr != nullptr)
8250 {
8251 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
8252
8253 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
8254 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
8255 else
8256 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
8257
8258 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
8259 {
8260 static bool said = false;
8261
8262 bl->loc_type = new_type;
8263 if (!said)
8264 {
8265 gdb_printf (_("Note: automatically using "
8266 "hardware breakpoints for "
8267 "read-only addresses.\n"));
8268 said = true;
8269 }
8270 }
8271 }
8272 }
8273 }
8274
8275 static struct bp_location *
8276 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8277 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8278 {
8279 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8280 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8281 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8282
8283 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8284 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8285
8286 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8287 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8288 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8289 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8290 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8291 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8292 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8293 sal->pc, b->type);
8294
8295 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8296 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8297 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8298 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8299 ;
8300 loc->next = *tmp;
8301 *tmp = loc;
8302
8303 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8304 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8305 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8306 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8307 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8308 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8309 loc->section = sal->section;
8310 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8311 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8312 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8313 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8314 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8315 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8316
8317 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
8318
8319 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8320 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8321 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8322 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8323 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8324 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8325 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8326 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8327 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8328 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8329 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8330 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8331 instruction.) */
8332 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8333 loc->permanent = 1;
8334
8335 return loc;
8336 }
8337 \f
8338
8339 /* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8340 return false otherwise. */
8341
8342 static bool
8343 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8344 {
8345 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8346
8347 /* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software
8348 watchpoint, just return 0. We should not attempt to read from
8349 the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to.
8350 gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8351 memory. */
8352 if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc))
8353 return false;
8354
8355 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8356 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8357 return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8358 }
8359
8360 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8361 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8362
8363 static void
8364 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8365 {
8366 const char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string.get ();
8367 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> printf_line = nullptr;
8368
8369 if (!dprintf_args)
8370 return;
8371
8372 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8373
8374 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8375 insist on it. */
8376 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8377 ++dprintf_args;
8378 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8379
8380 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8381 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8382
8383 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8384 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8385 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8386 {
8387 if (dprintf_function.empty ())
8388 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8389
8390 if (!dprintf_channel.empty ())
8391 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8392 dprintf_function.c_str (),
8393 dprintf_channel.c_str (),
8394 dprintf_args);
8395 else
8396 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8397 dprintf_function.c_str (),
8398 dprintf_args);
8399 }
8400 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8401 {
8402 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8403 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8404 else
8405 {
8406 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8407 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8408 }
8409 }
8410 else
8411 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8412 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8413
8414 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8415
8416 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8417 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8418 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line.release ());
8419 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8420 command_lines_deleter ()));
8421 }
8422
8423 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8424 current style settings. */
8425
8426 static void
8427 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8428 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8429 {
8430 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8431 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8432 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8433 }
8434
8435 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8436 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8437 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8438 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8439
8440 static void
8441 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8442 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8443 event_location_up &&location,
8444 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8445 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8446 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8447 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8448 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8449 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8450 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8451 int display_canonical)
8452 {
8453 int i;
8454
8455 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8456 {
8457 int target_resources_ok;
8458
8459 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8460 target_resources_ok =
8461 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8462 i + 1, 0);
8463 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8464 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8465 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8466 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8467 }
8468
8469 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8470
8471 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8472 {
8473 struct bp_location *loc;
8474
8475 if (from_tty)
8476 {
8477 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8478 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8479 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8480
8481 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8482 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8483 }
8484
8485 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8486 {
8487 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8488 b->thread = thread;
8489 b->task = task;
8490
8491 b->cond_string = std::move (cond_string);
8492 b->extra_string = std::move (extra_string);
8493 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8494 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8495 b->disposition = disposition;
8496
8497 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8498 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8499
8500 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8501 {
8502 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8503 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8504
8505 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8506 {
8507 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8508 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8509 const char *p
8510 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8511 const char *endp;
8512
8513 p = skip_spaces (p);
8514
8515 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8516
8517 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8518
8519 gdb_printf (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8520 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8521 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8522 }
8523 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8524 {
8525 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8526
8527 gdb_printf (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8528 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8529 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8530 }
8531 else
8532 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8533 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8534 }
8535
8536 loc = b->loc;
8537 }
8538 else
8539 {
8540 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8541 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8542 loc->inserted = 1;
8543 }
8544
8545 /* Do not set breakpoint locations conditions yet. As locations
8546 are inserted, they get sorted based on their addresses. Let
8547 the list stabilize to have reliable location numbers. */
8548
8549 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8550 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8551 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8552 {
8553 if (b->extra_string)
8554 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8555 else
8556 error (_("Format string required"));
8557 }
8558 else if (b->extra_string)
8559 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string.get ());
8560 }
8561
8562
8563 /* The order of the locations is now stable. Set the location
8564 condition using the location's number. */
8565 int loc_num = 1;
8566 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
8567 {
8568 if (b->cond_string != nullptr)
8569 set_breakpoint_location_condition (b->cond_string.get (), loc,
8570 b->number, loc_num);
8571
8572 ++loc_num;
8573 }
8574
8575 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8576 if (location != NULL)
8577 b->location = std::move (location);
8578 else
8579 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8580 b->filter = std::move (filter);
8581 }
8582
8583 static void
8584 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8585 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8586 event_location_up &&location,
8587 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8588 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8589 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8590 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8591 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8592 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8593 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8594 int display_canonical)
8595 {
8596 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8597
8598 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8599 sals, std::move (location),
8600 std::move (filter),
8601 std::move (cond_string),
8602 std::move (extra_string),
8603 type, disposition,
8604 thread, task, ignore_count,
8605 ops, from_tty,
8606 enabled, internal, flags,
8607 display_canonical);
8608
8609 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
8610 }
8611
8612 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8613 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8614 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8615 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8616 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8617 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8618 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8619 we take just a single condition string.
8620
8621 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8622 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8623 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8624 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8625 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8626
8627 static void
8628 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8629 struct linespec_result *canonical,
8630 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8631 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8632 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8633 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8634 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8635 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
8636 {
8637 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
8638 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
8639
8640 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
8641 {
8642 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8643 'break', without arguments. */
8644 event_location_up location
8645 = (canonical->location != NULL
8646 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
8647 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
8648 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
8649
8650 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
8651 std::move (location),
8652 std::move (filter_string),
8653 std::move (cond_string),
8654 std::move (extra_string),
8655 type, disposition,
8656 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
8657 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
8658 canonical->special_display);
8659 }
8660 }
8661
8662 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
8663 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
8664 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
8665 linespec locations).
8666
8667 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
8668 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
8669
8670 static void
8671 parse_breakpoint_sals (struct event_location *location,
8672 struct linespec_result *canonical)
8673 {
8674 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
8675
8676 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
8677 {
8678 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
8679
8680 if (spec == NULL)
8681 {
8682 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
8683 breakpoint address. */
8684 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
8685 {
8686 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
8687 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
8688 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
8689 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
8690 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
8691 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
8692 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
8693
8694 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8695
8696 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
8697 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
8698 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
8699 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
8700 instances with the same symtab and line. */
8701 sal.pc = pc;
8702 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8703
8704 struct linespec_sals lsal;
8705 lsal.sals = {sal};
8706 lsal.canonical = NULL;
8707
8708 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
8709 return;
8710 }
8711 else
8712 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
8713 }
8714 }
8715
8716 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
8717 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
8718 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
8719 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
8720
8721 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
8722 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
8723 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
8724 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
8725 {
8726 const char *spec = NULL;
8727
8728 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
8729 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
8730
8731 if (!cursal.symtab
8732 || (spec != NULL
8733 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
8734 && spec[1] != '['))
8735 {
8736 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
8737 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
8738 get_last_displayed_line (),
8739 canonical, NULL, NULL);
8740 return;
8741 }
8742 }
8743
8744 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
8745 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
8746 }
8747
8748
8749 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
8750 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
8751
8752 static void
8753 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
8754 {
8755 for (auto &sal : sals)
8756 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
8757 }
8758
8759 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
8760 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
8761 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
8762 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
8763 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
8764 it, etc. */
8765
8766 static void
8767 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8768 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
8769 {
8770 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8771 {
8772 struct gdbarch *sarch;
8773
8774 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8775 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
8776 associated with SAL. */
8777 if (sarch == NULL)
8778 sarch = gdbarch;
8779 std::string msg;
8780 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
8781 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
8782 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
8783 }
8784 }
8785
8786 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
8787 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
8788 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
8789 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
8790 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
8791 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
8792
8793 static void
8794 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
8795 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> *cond_string,
8796 int *thread, int *task,
8797 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> *rest)
8798 {
8799 cond_string->reset ();
8800 *thread = -1;
8801 *task = 0;
8802 rest->reset ();
8803 bool force = false;
8804
8805 while (tok && *tok)
8806 {
8807 const char *end_tok;
8808 int toklen;
8809 const char *cond_start = NULL;
8810 const char *cond_end = NULL;
8811
8812 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
8813
8814 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
8815 {
8816 rest->reset (savestring (tok, strlen (tok)));
8817 return;
8818 }
8819
8820 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
8821
8822 toklen = end_tok - tok;
8823
8824 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
8825 {
8826 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
8827 try
8828 {
8829 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
8830 }
8831 catch (const gdb_exception_error &)
8832 {
8833 if (!force)
8834 throw;
8835 else
8836 tok = tok + strlen (tok);
8837 }
8838 cond_end = tok;
8839 cond_string->reset (savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start));
8840 }
8841 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "-force-condition", toklen) == 0)
8842 {
8843 tok = tok + toklen;
8844 force = true;
8845 }
8846 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
8847 {
8848 const char *tmptok;
8849 struct thread_info *thr;
8850
8851 tok = end_tok + 1;
8852 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
8853 if (tok == tmptok)
8854 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
8855 *thread = thr->global_num;
8856 tok = tmptok;
8857 }
8858 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
8859 {
8860 char *tmptok;
8861
8862 tok = end_tok + 1;
8863 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
8864 if (tok == tmptok)
8865 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
8866 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
8867 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
8868 tok = tmptok;
8869 }
8870 else if (rest)
8871 {
8872 rest->reset (savestring (tok, strlen (tok)));
8873 return;
8874 }
8875 else
8876 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8877 }
8878 }
8879
8880 /* Call 'find_condition_and_thread' for each sal in SALS until a parse
8881 succeeds. The parsed values are written to COND_STRING, THREAD,
8882 TASK, and REST. See the comment of 'find_condition_and_thread'
8883 for the description of these parameters and INPUT. */
8884
8885 static void
8886 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (const std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals,
8887 const char *input,
8888 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> *cond_string,
8889 int *thread, int *task,
8890 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> *rest)
8891 {
8892 int num_failures = 0;
8893 for (auto &sal : sals)
8894 {
8895 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond;
8896 int thread_id = 0;
8897 int task_id = 0;
8898 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> remaining;
8899
8900 /* Here we want to parse 'arg' to separate condition from thread
8901 number. But because parsing happens in a context and the
8902 contexts of sals might be different, try each until there is
8903 success. Finding one successful parse is sufficient for our
8904 goal. When setting the breakpoint we'll re-parse the
8905 condition in the context of each sal. */
8906 try
8907 {
8908 find_condition_and_thread (input, sal.pc, &cond, &thread_id,
8909 &task_id, &remaining);
8910 *cond_string = std::move (cond);
8911 *thread = thread_id;
8912 *task = task_id;
8913 *rest = std::move (remaining);
8914 break;
8915 }
8916 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
8917 {
8918 num_failures++;
8919 /* If no sal remains, do not continue. */
8920 if (num_failures == sals.size ())
8921 throw;
8922 }
8923 }
8924 }
8925
8926 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
8927
8928 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
8929 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
8930 {
8931 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
8932 const char *endp;
8933
8934 p = skip_spaces (p);
8935
8936 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8937
8938 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
8939
8940 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
8941 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
8942 if (markers.empty ())
8943 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
8944 marker_str.c_str ());
8945
8946 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
8947 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
8948
8949 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
8950 {
8951 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
8952 sal.pc = marker.address;
8953 sals.push_back (sal);
8954 }
8955
8956 *arg_p = endp;
8957 return sals;
8958 }
8959
8960 /* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and
8961 according to IS_TRACEPOINT. */
8962
8963 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
8964 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type (enum event_location_type location_type,
8965 bool is_tracepoint)
8966 {
8967 if (is_tracepoint)
8968 {
8969 if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
8970 return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
8971 else
8972 return &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
8973 }
8974 else
8975 {
8976 if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
8977 return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
8978 else
8979 return &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
8980 }
8981 }
8982
8983 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8984
8985 const struct breakpoint_ops *
8986 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location (const struct event_location *location,
8987 bool is_tracepoint)
8988 {
8989 if (location != nullptr)
8990 return breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type
8991 (event_location_type (location), is_tracepoint);
8992 return is_tracepoint ? &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops : &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
8993 }
8994
8995 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8996
8997 int
8998 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8999 struct event_location *location,
9000 const char *cond_string,
9001 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9002 bool force_condition, int parse_extra,
9003 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9004 int ignore_count,
9005 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9006 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9007 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9008 unsigned flags)
9009 {
9010 struct linespec_result canonical;
9011 int pending = 0;
9012 int task = 0;
9013 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9014
9015 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9016
9017 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9018 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9019 extra_string = NULL;
9020
9021 try
9022 {
9023 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9024 }
9025 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
9026 {
9027 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9028 value. */
9029 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9030 {
9031 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9032 error. */
9033
9034 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9035 throw;
9036
9037 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9038
9039 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9040 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9041 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9042 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9043 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9044 return 0;
9045
9046 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9047 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9048 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9049 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9050 pending = 1;
9051 }
9052 else
9053 throw;
9054 }
9055
9056 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9057 return 0;
9058
9059 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9060 are ok for the target. */
9061 if (!pending)
9062 {
9063 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9064 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9065 }
9066
9067 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9068 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9069 {
9070 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9071 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9072 }
9073
9074 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9075 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9076 breakpoint. */
9077 if (!pending)
9078 {
9079 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9080 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9081
9082 if (parse_extra)
9083 {
9084 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> rest;
9085 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond;
9086
9087 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9088
9089 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (lsal.sals, extra_string,
9090 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9091 cond_string_copy = std::move (cond);
9092 extra_string_copy = std::move (rest);
9093 }
9094 else
9095 {
9096 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9097 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9098 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9099
9100 /* Check the validity of the condition. We should error out
9101 if the condition is invalid at all of the locations and
9102 if it is not forced. In the PARSE_EXTRA case above, this
9103 check is done when parsing the EXTRA_STRING. */
9104 if (cond_string != nullptr && !force_condition)
9105 {
9106 int num_failures = 0;
9107 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9108 for (const auto &sal : lsal.sals)
9109 {
9110 const char *cond = cond_string;
9111 try
9112 {
9113 parse_exp_1 (&cond, sal.pc, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0);
9114 /* One success is sufficient to keep going. */
9115 break;
9116 }
9117 catch (const gdb_exception_error &)
9118 {
9119 num_failures++;
9120 /* If this is the last sal, error out. */
9121 if (num_failures == lsal.sals.size ())
9122 throw;
9123 }
9124 }
9125 }
9126
9127 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9128 if (cond_string)
9129 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9130 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9131 if (extra_string)
9132 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9133 }
9134
9135 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9136 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9137 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9138 type_wanted,
9139 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9140 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9141 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9142 }
9143 else
9144 {
9145 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9146
9147 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9148 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9149
9150 if (parse_extra)
9151 b->cond_string = NULL;
9152 else
9153 {
9154 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9155 b->cond_string.reset (cond_string != NULL
9156 ? xstrdup (cond_string)
9157 : NULL);
9158 b->thread = thread;
9159 }
9160
9161 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9162 b->extra_string.reset (extra_string != NULL
9163 ? xstrdup (extra_string)
9164 : NULL);
9165 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9166 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9167 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9168 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9169 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9170 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9171 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9172
9173 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9174 }
9175
9176 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9177 {
9178 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9179 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9180 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9181 }
9182
9183 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9184
9185 return 1;
9186 }
9187
9188 /* Set a breakpoint.
9189 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9190 condition, and thread.
9191 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9192 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9193 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9194
9195 static void
9196 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9197 {
9198 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9199 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9200 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9201 : bp_breakpoint);
9202
9203 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9204 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
9205 (location.get (), false /* is_tracepoint */);
9206
9207 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9208 location.get (),
9209 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
9210 tempflag, type_wanted,
9211 0 /* Ignore count */,
9212 pending_break_support,
9213 ops,
9214 from_tty,
9215 1 /* enabled */,
9216 0 /* internal */,
9217 0);
9218 }
9219
9220 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9221
9222 void
9223 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9224 {
9225 CORE_ADDR pc;
9226
9227 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9228 {
9229 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9230 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9231 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9232 sal->pc = pc;
9233
9234 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9235 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9236 if (sal->explicit_line)
9237 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9238 }
9239
9240 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9241 {
9242 const struct blockvector *bv;
9243 const struct block *b;
9244 struct symbol *sym;
9245
9246 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9247 sal->symtab->compunit ());
9248 if (bv != NULL)
9249 {
9250 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9251 if (sym != NULL)
9252 {
9253 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->compunit ()->objfile ());
9254 sal->section
9255 = sym->obj_section (sal->symtab->compunit ()->objfile ());
9256 }
9257 else
9258 {
9259 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9260 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9261 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9262 happen in assembly source). */
9263
9264 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9265 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9266
9267 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9268 if (msym.minsym)
9269 sal->section = msym.obj_section ();
9270 }
9271 }
9272 }
9273 }
9274
9275 void
9276 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9277 {
9278 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9279 }
9280
9281 void
9282 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9283 {
9284 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9285 }
9286
9287 static void
9288 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9289 {
9290 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9291 }
9292
9293 static void
9294 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9295 {
9296 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9297 }
9298
9299 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9300 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9301 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9302 line. */
9303
9304 static void
9305 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9306 {
9307 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9308
9309 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9310 the next character must be ','. */
9311 if (arg != NULL)
9312 {
9313 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9314 error (_("Format string required"));
9315 else
9316 {
9317 /* Skip the comma. */
9318 ++arg;
9319 }
9320 }
9321
9322 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9323 location.get (),
9324 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
9325 0, bp_dprintf,
9326 0 /* Ignore count */,
9327 pending_break_support,
9328 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9329 from_tty,
9330 1 /* enabled */,
9331 0 /* internal */,
9332 0);
9333 }
9334
9335 static void
9336 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9337 {
9338 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9339 }
9340
9341 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9342 ranged breakpoints. */
9343
9344 static int
9345 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9346 const address_space *aspace,
9347 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9348 const target_waitstatus &ws)
9349 {
9350 if (ws.kind () != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9351 || ws.sig () != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9352 return 0;
9353
9354 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9355 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9356 }
9357
9358 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9359 ranged breakpoints. */
9360
9361 static int
9362 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9363 {
9364 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9365 }
9366
9367 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9368 ranged breakpoints. */
9369
9370 static enum print_stop_action
9371 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat *bs)
9372 {
9373 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9374 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9375 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9376
9377 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9378
9379 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9380 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9381
9382 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9383
9384 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9385
9386 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9387 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9388 else
9389 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9390 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9391 {
9392 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9393 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9394 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9395 }
9396 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
9397 uiout->text (", ");
9398
9399 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9400 }
9401
9402 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9403 ranged breakpoints. */
9404
9405 static void
9406 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9407 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9408 {
9409 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9410 struct value_print_options opts;
9411 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9412
9413 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9414 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9415
9416 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9417
9418 if (opts.addressprint)
9419 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9420 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9421 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9422 annotate_field (5);
9423 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9424 *last_loc = bl;
9425 }
9426
9427 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9428 ranged breakpoints. */
9429
9430 static void
9431 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9432 struct ui_out *uiout)
9433 {
9434 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9435 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9436 string_file stb;
9437
9438 gdb_assert (bl);
9439
9440 address_start = bl->address;
9441 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9442
9443 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9444 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9445 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9446 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9447 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9448 uiout->text ("\n");
9449 }
9450
9451 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9452 ranged breakpoints. */
9453
9454 static void
9455 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9456 {
9457 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9458 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9459
9460 gdb_assert (bl);
9461 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9462
9463 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9464 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9465 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9466 }
9467
9468 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9469 ranged breakpoints. */
9470
9471 static void
9472 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9473 {
9474 gdb_printf (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9475 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9476 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9477 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9478 }
9479
9480 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9481
9482 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9483
9484 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9485 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9486 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9487 last instruction of the given line. */
9488
9489 static CORE_ADDR
9490 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9491 {
9492 CORE_ADDR end;
9493
9494 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9495 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9496 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9497 end = sal.pc;
9498 else
9499 {
9500 int ret;
9501 CORE_ADDR start;
9502
9503 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9504 if (!ret)
9505 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9506
9507 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9508 end--;
9509 }
9510
9511 return end;
9512 }
9513
9514 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9515
9516 static void
9517 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9518 {
9519 const char *arg_start;
9520 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9521 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9522 CORE_ADDR end;
9523 struct breakpoint *b;
9524
9525 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9526 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9527 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9528
9529 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9530 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9531 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9532 bp_count, 0);
9533 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9534 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9535
9536 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9537 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9538 error(_("No address range specified."));
9539
9540 arg_start = arg;
9541 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9542 current_language);
9543 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9544
9545 if (arg[0] != ',')
9546 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9547 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9548 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9549
9550 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9551
9552 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9553 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9554 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9555
9556 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9557 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9558
9559 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9560 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9561
9562 /* Parse the end location. */
9563
9564 arg_start = arg;
9565
9566 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9567 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9568 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9569 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9570 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9571 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9572 current_language);
9573 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9574 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9575 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9576
9577 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
9578 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9579
9580 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
9581 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
9582 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
9583 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9584
9585 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
9586
9587 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9588 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9589 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9590
9591 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9592 if (length < 0)
9593 /* Length overflowed. */
9594 error (_("Address range too large."));
9595 else if (length == 1)
9596 {
9597 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9598 the `hbreak' command. */
9599 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
9600
9601 return;
9602 }
9603
9604 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9605 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9606 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9607 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9608 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9609 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9610 b->location = std::move (start_location);
9611 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
9612 b->loc->length = length;
9613
9614 mention (b);
9615 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
9616 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9617 }
9618
9619 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9620 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9621 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9622 zero. */
9623
9624 static bool
9625 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
9626 {
9627 return exp->op->constant_p ();
9628 }
9629
9630 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
9631
9632 static void
9633 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9634 {
9635 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
9636
9637 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
9638 variables, or it can be on local variables.
9639
9640 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
9641 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
9642 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
9643 are loaded and unloaded.
9644
9645 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9646 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
9647 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
9648 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
9649 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
9650 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9651
9652 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9653 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
9654 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9655 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9656
9657 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9658 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9659
9660 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
9661 reevaluated again when enabled. */
9662 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
9663 }
9664
9665 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
9666
9667 static int
9668 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
9669 {
9670 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
9671 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
9672
9673 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
9674 w->cond_exp.get ());
9675 }
9676
9677 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
9678
9679 static int
9680 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
9681 {
9682 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
9683 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
9684
9685 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
9686 w->cond_exp.get ());
9687 }
9688
9689 static int
9690 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9691 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9692 const target_waitstatus &ws)
9693 {
9694 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
9695 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
9696
9697 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
9698 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
9699 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
9700 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
9701 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
9702 (did not match the data address). */
9703 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
9704 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
9705 return 0;
9706
9707 return 1;
9708 }
9709
9710 static void
9711 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat *bs)
9712 {
9713 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
9714
9715 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
9716 }
9717
9718 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9719 hardware watchpoints. */
9720
9721 static int
9722 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9723 {
9724 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
9725 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
9726
9727 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
9728 }
9729
9730 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
9731 hardware watchpoints. */
9732
9733 static int
9734 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
9735 {
9736 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
9737 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
9738 }
9739
9740 static enum print_stop_action
9741 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat *bs)
9742 {
9743 struct breakpoint *b;
9744 enum print_stop_action result;
9745 struct watchpoint *w;
9746 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9747
9748 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
9749
9750 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9751 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
9752
9753 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
9754 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9755
9756 string_file stb;
9757
9758 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
9759 switch (b->type)
9760 {
9761 case bp_watchpoint:
9762 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9763 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9764 uiout->field_string
9765 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
9766 mention (b);
9767 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
9768 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
9769 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
9770 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
9771 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
9772 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
9773 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
9774 uiout->text ("\n");
9775 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
9776 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
9777 break;
9778
9779 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9780 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9781 uiout->field_string
9782 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
9783 mention (b);
9784 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
9785 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
9786 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
9787 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
9788 uiout->text ("\n");
9789 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
9790 break;
9791
9792 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9793 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
9794 {
9795 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9796 uiout->field_string
9797 ("reason",
9798 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
9799 mention (b);
9800 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
9801 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
9802 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
9803 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
9804 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
9805 }
9806 else
9807 {
9808 mention (b);
9809 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9810 uiout->field_string
9811 ("reason",
9812 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
9813 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
9814 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
9815 }
9816 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
9817 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
9818 uiout->text ("\n");
9819 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
9820 break;
9821 default:
9822 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
9823 }
9824
9825 return result;
9826 }
9827
9828 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
9829 watchpoints. */
9830
9831 static void
9832 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9833 {
9834 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
9835 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9836 const char *tuple_name;
9837
9838 switch (b->type)
9839 {
9840 case bp_watchpoint:
9841 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
9842 tuple_name = "wpt";
9843 break;
9844 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9845 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
9846 tuple_name = "wpt";
9847 break;
9848 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9849 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
9850 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
9851 break;
9852 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9853 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
9854 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
9855 break;
9856 default:
9857 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9858 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
9859 }
9860
9861 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
9862 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
9863 uiout->text (": ");
9864 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string.get ());
9865 }
9866
9867 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9868 watchpoints. */
9869
9870 static void
9871 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9872 {
9873 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
9874
9875 switch (b->type)
9876 {
9877 case bp_watchpoint:
9878 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9879 gdb_printf (fp, "watch");
9880 break;
9881 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9882 gdb_printf (fp, "rwatch");
9883 break;
9884 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9885 gdb_printf (fp, "awatch");
9886 break;
9887 default:
9888 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9889 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
9890 }
9891
9892 gdb_printf (fp, " %s", w->exp_string.get ());
9893 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9894 }
9895
9896 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
9897 watchpoints. */
9898
9899 static int
9900 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
9901 {
9902 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
9903 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
9904 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9905 return 0;
9906
9907 return 1;
9908 }
9909
9910 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
9911
9912 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
9913
9914 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
9915 masked hardware watchpoints. */
9916
9917 static int
9918 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
9919 {
9920 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
9921
9922 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
9923 bl->watchpoint_type);
9924 }
9925
9926 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
9927 masked hardware watchpoints. */
9928
9929 static int
9930 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
9931 {
9932 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
9933
9934 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
9935 bl->watchpoint_type);
9936 }
9937
9938 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9939 masked hardware watchpoints. */
9940
9941 static int
9942 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9943 {
9944 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
9945
9946 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
9947 }
9948
9949 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
9950 masked hardware watchpoints. */
9951
9952 static int
9953 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
9954 {
9955 return 0;
9956 }
9957
9958 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9959 masked hardware watchpoints. */
9960
9961 static enum print_stop_action
9962 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat *bs)
9963 {
9964 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9965 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9966
9967 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
9968 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
9969
9970 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
9971 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9972
9973 switch (b->type)
9974 {
9975 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9976 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9977 uiout->field_string
9978 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
9979 break;
9980
9981 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9982 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9983 uiout->field_string
9984 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
9985 break;
9986
9987 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9988 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9989 uiout->field_string
9990 ("reason",
9991 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
9992 break;
9993 default:
9994 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9995 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
9996 }
9997
9998 mention (b);
9999 uiout->text (_("\n\
10000 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10001 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10002 uiout->text ("\n");
10003
10004 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10005 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10006 }
10007
10008 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10009 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10010
10011 static void
10012 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10013 struct ui_out *uiout)
10014 {
10015 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10016
10017 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10018 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10019
10020 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10021 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10022 uiout->text ("\n");
10023 }
10024
10025 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10026 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10027
10028 static void
10029 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10030 {
10031 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10032 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10033 const char *tuple_name;
10034
10035 switch (b->type)
10036 {
10037 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10038 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10039 tuple_name = "wpt";
10040 break;
10041 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10042 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10043 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10044 break;
10045 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10046 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10047 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10048 break;
10049 default:
10050 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10051 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10052 }
10053
10054 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10055 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
10056 uiout->text (": ");
10057 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string.get ());
10058 }
10059
10060 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10061 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10062
10063 static void
10064 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10065 {
10066 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10067
10068 switch (b->type)
10069 {
10070 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10071 gdb_printf (fp, "watch");
10072 break;
10073 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10074 gdb_printf (fp, "rwatch");
10075 break;
10076 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10077 gdb_printf (fp, "awatch");
10078 break;
10079 default:
10080 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10081 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10082 }
10083
10084 gdb_printf (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string.get (),
10085 phex (w->hw_wp_mask, sizeof (CORE_ADDR)));
10086 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10087 }
10088
10089 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10090
10091 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10092
10093 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10094
10095 static bool
10096 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10097 {
10098 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10099 }
10100
10101 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10102 hw_read: watch read,
10103 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10104 static void
10105 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10106 bool just_location, bool internal)
10107 {
10108 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10109 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10110 struct value *result;
10111 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10112 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10113 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10114 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10115 int toklen = -1;
10116 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10117 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10118 enum bptype bp_type;
10119 int thread = -1;
10120 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10121 the hardware watchpoint. */
10122 bool use_mask = false;
10123 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10124 int task = 0;
10125
10126 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10127 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10128 {
10129 const char *value_start;
10130
10131 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10132
10133 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10134 of the arguments string. */
10135 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10136 {
10137 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10138 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10139 tok--;
10140
10141 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10142 This is the value of the parameter. */
10143 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10144 tok--;
10145 value_start = tok + 1;
10146
10147 /* Skip whitespace. */
10148 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10149 tok--;
10150
10151 end_tok = tok;
10152
10153 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10154 This is the parameter itself. */
10155 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10156 tok--;
10157 tok++;
10158 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10159
10160 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10161 {
10162 struct thread_info *thr;
10163 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10164 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10165 only in a specific thread. */
10166 const char *endp;
10167
10168 if (thread != -1)
10169 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10170
10171 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10172 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10173
10174 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10175 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10176 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10177
10178 thread = thr->global_num;
10179 }
10180 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "task"))
10181 {
10182 char *tmp;
10183
10184 task = strtol (value_start, &tmp, 0);
10185 if (tmp == value_start)
10186 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
10187 if (!valid_task_id (task))
10188 error (_("Unknown task %d."), task);
10189 }
10190 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10191 {
10192 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10193 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10194 facility. */
10195 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10196
10197 if (use_mask)
10198 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10199
10200 use_mask = just_location = true;
10201
10202 mark = value_mark ();
10203 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10204 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10205 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10206 }
10207 else
10208 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10209 break;
10210
10211 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10212 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10213 exp_end = tok;
10214 }
10215 }
10216 else
10217 exp_end = arg;
10218
10219 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10220 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10221 ARG. */
10222 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10223 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10224 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
10225 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
10226 exp_end = arg;
10227 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10228 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10229 prettier. */
10230 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10231 --exp_end;
10232
10233 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10234 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10235 {
10236 int len;
10237
10238 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10239 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10240 len--;
10241 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10242 }
10243
10244 exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
10245 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
10246 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10247 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), exp->op.get (), &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10248 just_location);
10249
10250 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10251 {
10252 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10253 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10254 }
10255
10256 value_ref_ptr val;
10257 if (just_location)
10258 {
10259 int ret;
10260
10261 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10262 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10263 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10264
10265 if (use_mask)
10266 {
10267 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10268 mask);
10269 if (ret == -1)
10270 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10271 else if (ret == -2)
10272 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10273 }
10274 }
10275 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10276 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10277
10278 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10279 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10280
10281 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10282 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10283 {
10284 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10285 innermost_block_tracker if_tracker;
10286 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker);
10287
10288 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10289 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10290 cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block ();
10291
10292 cond_end = tok;
10293 }
10294 if (*tok)
10295 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10296
10297 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10298
10299 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10300 'wp_frame'. */
10301 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10302
10303 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10304 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10305 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10306 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10307 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10308 {
10309 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10310
10311 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10312 {
10313 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10314 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10315
10316 scope_breakpoint
10317 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10318 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10319 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10320
10321 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10322 wp_frame = NULL;
10323
10324 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10325
10326 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10327 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10328
10329 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10330 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10331
10332 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10333 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10334 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10335 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10336 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10337 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10338 scope_breakpoint->type);
10339 }
10340 }
10341
10342 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10343 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10344 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10345 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10346
10347 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10348 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10349 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10350 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10351 else
10352 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10353
10354 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10355
10356 if (use_mask)
10357 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10358 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10359 else
10360 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10361 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10362 w->thread = thread;
10363 w->task = task;
10364 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10365 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10366 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10367 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10368 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10369 if (just_location)
10370 {
10371 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10372 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10373
10374 w->exp_string_reparse
10375 = current_language->watch_location_expression (t, addr);
10376
10377 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10378 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10379 }
10380 else
10381 w->exp_string.reset (savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start));
10382
10383 if (use_mask)
10384 {
10385 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10386 }
10387 else
10388 {
10389 w->val = val;
10390 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10391 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10392 w->val_valid = true;
10393 }
10394
10395 if (cond_start)
10396 w->cond_string.reset (savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start));
10397 else
10398 w->cond_string = 0;
10399
10400 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10401 {
10402 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10403 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10404 }
10405 else
10406 {
10407 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10408 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10409 }
10410
10411 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10412 {
10413 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10414 need to act on them together. */
10415 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10416 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10417 }
10418
10419 if (!just_location)
10420 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10421
10422 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10423 that should be inserted. */
10424 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10425
10426 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10427 }
10428
10429 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10430 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10431
10432 static int
10433 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10434 {
10435 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10436
10437 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10438 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10439 return 0;
10440
10441 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10442 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10443
10444 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10445 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10446 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10447 hardware watchpoint.
10448
10449 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10450 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10451 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10452 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10453 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10454 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10455 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10456 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10457 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10458
10459 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10460 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10461 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10462 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10463 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10464 {
10465 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10466
10467 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10468 {
10469 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10470 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10471 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10472 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10473 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10474 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10475 ;
10476 else
10477 {
10478 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10479 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10480 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10481
10482 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10483 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10484 middle of some value chain. */
10485 if (v == head
10486 || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10487 && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10488 {
10489 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10490 int len;
10491 int num_regs;
10492
10493 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10494 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10495 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10496
10497 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10498 if (!num_regs)
10499 return 0;
10500 else
10501 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10502 }
10503 }
10504 }
10505 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10506 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10507 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10508 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10509 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10510 }
10511
10512 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10513 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10514 return found_memory_cnt;
10515 }
10516
10517 void
10518 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
10519 {
10520 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10521 }
10522
10523 /* Options for the watch, awatch, and rwatch commands. */
10524
10525 struct watch_options
10526 {
10527 /* For -location. */
10528 bool location = false;
10529 };
10530
10531 /* Definitions of options for the "watch", "awatch", and "rwatch" commands.
10532
10533 Historically GDB always accepted both '-location' and '-l' flags for
10534 these commands (both flags being synonyms). When converting to the
10535 newer option scheme only '-location' is added here. That's fine (for
10536 backward compatibility) as any non-ambiguous prefix of a flag will be
10537 accepted, so '-l', '-loc', are now all accepted.
10538
10539 What this means is that, if in the future, we add any new flag here
10540 that starts with '-l' then this will break backward compatibility, so
10541 please, don't do that! */
10542
10543 static const gdb::option::option_def watch_option_defs[] = {
10544 gdb::option::flag_option_def<watch_options> {
10545 "location",
10546 [] (watch_options *opt) { return &opt->location; },
10547 N_("\
10548 This evaluates EXPRESSION and watches the memory to which is refers.\n\
10549 -l can be used as a short form of -location."),
10550 },
10551 };
10552
10553 /* Returns the option group used by 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch'
10554 commands. */
10555
10556 static gdb::option::option_def_group
10557 make_watch_options_def_group (watch_options *opts)
10558 {
10559 return {{watch_option_defs}, opts};
10560 }
10561
10562 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10563 calls watch_command_1. */
10564
10565 static void
10566 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
10567 {
10568 watch_options opts;
10569 auto grp = make_watch_options_def_group (&opts);
10570 gdb::option::process_options
10571 (&arg, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, grp);
10572 if (arg != nullptr && *arg == '\0')
10573 arg = nullptr;
10574
10575 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, opts.location, false);
10576 }
10577
10578 /* Command completion for 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' commands. */
10579 static void
10580 watch_command_completer (struct cmd_list_element *ignore,
10581 completion_tracker &tracker,
10582 const char *text, const char * /*word*/)
10583 {
10584 const auto group = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr);
10585 if (gdb::option::complete_options
10586 (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, group))
10587 return;
10588
10589 const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text);
10590 expression_completer (ignore, tracker, text, word);
10591 }
10592
10593 static void
10594 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10595 {
10596 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
10597 }
10598
10599 void
10600 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
10601 {
10602 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
10603 }
10604
10605 static void
10606 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10607 {
10608 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
10609 }
10610
10611 void
10612 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
10613 {
10614 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
10615 }
10616
10617 static void
10618 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10619 {
10620 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
10621 }
10622 \f
10623
10624 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
10625 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
10626 breakpoints. */
10627
10628 struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm
10629 {
10630 /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */
10631 int thread;
10632
10633 /* The breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame,
10634 plus breakpoints at all the destination locations. */
10635 std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints;
10636
10637 until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
10638 std::vector<breakpoint_up> &&breakpoints)
10639 : thread_fsm (cmd_interp),
10640 thread (thread),
10641 breakpoints (std::move (breakpoints))
10642 {
10643 }
10644
10645 void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override;
10646 bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override;
10647 enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override;
10648 };
10649
10650 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
10651 until(location)/advance commands. */
10652
10653 bool
10654 until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp)
10655 {
10656 for (const breakpoint_up &bp : breakpoints)
10657 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
10658 bp.get ()) != NULL)
10659 {
10660 set_finished ();
10661 break;
10662 }
10663
10664 return true;
10665 }
10666
10667 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
10668 until(location)/advance commands. */
10669
10670 void
10671 until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *)
10672 {
10673 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
10674 breakpoints.clear ();
10675 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread);
10676 }
10677
10678 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
10679 until(location)/advance commands. */
10680
10681 enum async_reply_reason
10682 until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason ()
10683 {
10684 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
10685 }
10686
10687 void
10688 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
10689 {
10690 struct frame_info *frame;
10691 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
10692 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
10693 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
10694 int thread;
10695 struct thread_info *tp;
10696
10697 clear_proceed_status (0);
10698
10699 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
10700 this function. */
10701
10702 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10703
10704 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
10705 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
10706 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
10707 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
10708 get_last_displayed_line ())
10709 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
10710 NULL, NULL, 0));
10711
10712 if (sals.empty ())
10713 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
10714
10715 if (*arg)
10716 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10717
10718 tp = inferior_thread ();
10719 thread = tp->global_num;
10720
10721 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
10722 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
10723 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
10724 that. */
10725
10726 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
10727 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
10728 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
10729 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
10730
10731 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
10732 one. */
10733
10734 std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints;
10735
10736 gdb::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter;
10737
10738 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10739 {
10740 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
10741 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
10742
10743 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
10744 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
10745 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
10746
10747 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint
10748 = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch, sal2,
10749 caller_frame_id, bp_until);
10750 breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (caller_breakpoint));
10751
10752 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
10753 lj_deleter.emplace (thread);
10754 }
10755
10756 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
10757 frame = NULL;
10758
10759 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location, we
10760 don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. Otherwise,
10761 specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only at the
10762 very same frame. */
10763 frame_id stop_frame_id = anywhere ? null_frame_id : stack_frame_id;
10764
10765 for (symtab_and_line &sal : sals)
10766 {
10767 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
10768
10769 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint
10770 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
10771 stop_frame_id, bp_until);
10772 breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (location_breakpoint));
10773 }
10774
10775 tp->set_thread_fsm
10776 (std::unique_ptr<thread_fsm>
10777 (new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
10778 std::move (breakpoints))));
10779
10780 if (lj_deleter)
10781 lj_deleter->release ();
10782
10783 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
10784 }
10785
10786 void
10787 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
10788 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
10789 struct symtab_and_line sal,
10790 const char *addr_string,
10791 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
10792 int tempflag,
10793 int enabled,
10794 int from_tty)
10795 {
10796 if (from_tty)
10797 {
10798 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
10799 if (!loc_gdbarch)
10800 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
10801
10802 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
10803 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
10804 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
10805 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
10806 used for different exception names will use the same address.
10807 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
10808 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
10809 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
10810 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
10811 enough for now, though. */
10812 }
10813
10814 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
10815
10816 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
10817 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
10818 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
10819 language_def (language_ada));
10820 b->language = language_ada;
10821 }
10822
10823 \f
10824
10825 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
10826
10827 static int
10828 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
10829 {
10830 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
10831 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
10832
10833 if (a->number < b->number)
10834 return -1;
10835 else if (a->number > b->number)
10836 return 1;
10837
10838 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
10839 the number 0. */
10840 if (ua < ub)
10841 return -1;
10842 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
10843 }
10844
10845 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
10846
10847 static void
10848 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10849 {
10850 int default_match;
10851
10852 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
10853 symtab_and_line last_sal;
10854 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
10855 if (arg)
10856 {
10857 decoded_sals
10858 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
10859 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
10860 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
10861 default_match = 0;
10862 sals = decoded_sals;
10863 }
10864 else
10865 {
10866 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
10867 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
10868 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
10869 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
10870 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
10871 error (_("No source file specified."));
10872
10873 default_match = 1;
10874 sals = last_sal;
10875 }
10876
10877 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
10878 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
10879 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
10880 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
10881
10882 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
10883 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
10884 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
10885 due to optimization, all in one block.
10886
10887 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
10888 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
10889 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
10890 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
10891 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
10892 to support that. */
10893
10894 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
10895 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
10896 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
10897 breakpoint. */
10898
10899 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
10900 for (const auto &sal : sals)
10901 {
10902 const char *sal_fullname;
10903
10904 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
10905 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
10906 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
10907 or at default pc.
10908
10909 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
10910
10911 0 1 pc
10912 1 1 pc _and_ line
10913 0 0 line
10914 1 0 <can't happen> */
10915
10916 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
10917 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
10918
10919 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
10920 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
10921 {
10922 int match = 0;
10923 /* Are we going to delete b? */
10924 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b)
10925 && user_breakpoint_p (b))
10926 {
10927 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
10928 {
10929 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
10930 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
10931 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
10932 && sal.pc
10933 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
10934 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
10935 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
10936 || loc->section == sal.section));
10937 int line_match = 0;
10938
10939 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
10940 && loc->symtab != NULL
10941 && sal_fullname != NULL
10942 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
10943 && loc->line_number == sal.line
10944 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
10945 sal_fullname) == 0)
10946 line_match = 1;
10947
10948 if (pc_match || line_match)
10949 {
10950 match = 1;
10951 break;
10952 }
10953 }
10954 }
10955
10956 if (match)
10957 found.push_back (b);
10958 }
10959 }
10960
10961 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
10962 if (found.empty ())
10963 {
10964 if (arg)
10965 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
10966 else
10967 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
10968 }
10969
10970 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
10971 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
10972 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
10973 {
10974 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
10975 });
10976 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
10977 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
10978 {
10979 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
10980 }),
10981 found.end ());
10982
10983 if (found.size () > 1)
10984 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
10985 if (from_tty)
10986 {
10987 if (found.size () == 1)
10988 gdb_printf (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
10989 else
10990 gdb_printf (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
10991 }
10992
10993 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
10994 {
10995 if (from_tty)
10996 gdb_printf ("%d ", iter->number);
10997 delete_breakpoint (iter);
10998 }
10999 if (from_tty)
11000 gdb_putc ('\n');
11001 }
11002 \f
11003 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11004 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11005 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11006
11007 void
11008 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat *bs)
11009 {
11010 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11011 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11012 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11013 && bs->stop)
11014 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11015
11016 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
11017 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11018 delete_breakpoint (b);
11019 }
11020
11021 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11022 std::sort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11023 bl_address_is_meaningful says), secondarily by ordering first
11024 permanent elements and terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted
11025 stable way despite std::sort being an unstable algorithm. */
11026
11027 static int
11028 bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location *a, const bp_location *b)
11029 {
11030 if (a->address != b->address)
11031 return a->address < b->address;
11032
11033 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11034 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11035 grouped. */
11036
11037 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11038 return a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num;
11039
11040 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11041 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11042 return a->permanent > b->permanent;
11043
11044 /* Sort by type in order to make duplicate determination easier.
11045 See update_global_location_list. This is kept in sync with
11046 breakpoint_locations_match. */
11047 if (a->loc_type < b->loc_type)
11048 return true;
11049
11050 /* Likewise, for range-breakpoints, sort by length. */
11051 if (a->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
11052 && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
11053 && a->length < b->length)
11054 return true;
11055
11056 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11057 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11058 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11059
11060 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11061 return a->owner->number < b->owner->number;
11062
11063 return a < b;
11064 }
11065
11066 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11067 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11068 content of the bp_locations array. */
11069
11070 static void
11071 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11072 {
11073 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11074 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11075
11076 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
11077 {
11078 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11079
11080 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11081 continue;
11082
11083 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11084 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11085
11086 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11087 addr = bl->address - start;
11088 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11089 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11090
11091 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11092
11093 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11094 addr = end - bl->address;
11095 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11096 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11097 }
11098 }
11099
11100 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11101
11102 static void
11103 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11104 {
11105 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11106
11107 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11108
11109 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
11110 {
11111 struct tracepoint *t;
11112 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11113
11114 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11115 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11116 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11117 continue;
11118
11119 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11120 {
11121 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11122 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11123 else
11124 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11125 }
11126
11127 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11128 break;
11129
11130 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
11131 {
11132 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11133 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11134 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11135 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11136 continue;
11137
11138 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11139
11140 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11141
11142 bl->inserted = 1;
11143 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11144 }
11145 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11146 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11147 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11148 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11149 }
11150 }
11151
11152 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11153
11154 static void
11155 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11156 {
11157 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11158 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11159 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11160 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11161
11162 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11163 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11164 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11165 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11166 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11167
11168 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11169 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11170 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11171 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11172 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11173 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11174 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11175 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11176 }
11177
11178 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11179 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11180 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11181 the target. */
11182
11183 static void
11184 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11185 {
11186 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11187 int pspace_num;
11188
11189 address = bl->address;
11190 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11191
11192 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11193 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11194 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11195 side. */
11196 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11197 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11198 return;
11199
11200 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11201 the same program space as the location
11202 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11203 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11204 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations_at_addr (address))
11205 {
11206 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11207 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11208 continue;
11209
11210 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11211 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11212 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11213 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11214 that have already been marked. */
11215 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11216
11217 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11218 it later on. */
11219 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11220 }
11221 }
11222
11223 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11224 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11225 locations are duplicate of which.
11226
11227 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11228 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11229 info. */
11230
11231 static void
11232 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11233 {
11234 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11235 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11236 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11237 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11238
11239 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11240 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11241 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11242 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11243 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11244 once. */
11245 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11246 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11247 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11248 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11249
11250 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11251 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11252 std::vector<bp_location *> old_locations = std::move (bp_locations);
11253 bp_locations.clear ();
11254
11255 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
11256 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
11257 bp_locations.push_back (loc);
11258
11259 /* See if we need to "upgrade" a software breakpoint to a hardware
11260 breakpoint. Do this before deciding whether locations are
11261 duplicates. Also do this before sorting because sorting order
11262 depends on location type. */
11263 for (bp_location *loc : bp_locations)
11264 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
11265 handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (loc);
11266
11267 std::sort (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (),
11268 bp_location_is_less_than);
11269
11270 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11271
11272 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11273 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11274 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11275 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11276 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11277 location.
11278
11279 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11280 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11281
11282 size_t loc_i = 0;
11283 for (bp_location *old_loc : old_locations)
11284 {
11285 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11286 not, we have to free it. */
11287 int found_object = 0;
11288 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11289 int keep_in_target = 0;
11290 int removed = 0;
11291
11292 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11293 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11294 while (loc_i < bp_locations.size ()
11295 && bp_locations[loc_i]->address < old_loc->address)
11296 loc_i++;
11297
11298 for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i;
11299 (loc2_i < bp_locations.size ()
11300 && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address);
11301 loc2_i++)
11302 {
11303 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11304 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11305 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11306 place there. */
11307 if (bp_locations[loc2_i]->condition_changed == condition_modified
11308 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11309 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11310 {
11311 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (bp_locations[loc2_i]);
11312 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11313 }
11314
11315 if (bp_locations[loc2_i] == old_loc)
11316 found_object = 1;
11317 }
11318
11319 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11320 have to go through updates again. */
11321 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11322
11323 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11324 if (!found_object)
11325 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11326
11327 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11328 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11329 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11330 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11331 at certain location is not inserted. */
11332
11333 if (old_loc->inserted)
11334 {
11335 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11336 it. */
11337
11338 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11339 {
11340 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11341 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11342 keep_in_target = 1;
11343 }
11344 else
11345 {
11346 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11347 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11348 remove its target-side condition. */
11349
11350 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11351 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11352 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11353 this one from the target. */
11354
11355 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11356 if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc))
11357 {
11358 for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i;
11359 (loc2_i < bp_locations.size ()
11360 && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address);
11361 loc2_i++)
11362 {
11363 bp_location *loc2 = bp_locations[loc2_i];
11364
11365 if (loc2 == old_loc)
11366 continue;
11367
11368 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11369 {
11370 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11371 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11372 supported, but the latter are. */
11373 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11374 {
11375 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11376 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11377 }
11378
11379 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11380 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11381 unduplicated. */
11382 if (unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11383 {
11384 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11385 keep_in_target = 1;
11386 break;
11387 }
11388 }
11389 }
11390 }
11391 }
11392
11393 if (!keep_in_target)
11394 {
11395 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11396 {
11397 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11398 this location on the global list, and try to
11399 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11400 reason why we will succeed next time.
11401
11402 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11403 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11404 only after calling us. */
11405 gdb_printf (_("warning: Error removing "
11406 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11407 old_loc->owner->number);
11408 }
11409 removed = 1;
11410 }
11411 }
11412
11413 if (!found_object)
11414 {
11415 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11416 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11417 {
11418 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11419 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11420 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11421 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11422 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11423 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11424 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11425 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11426 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11427 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11428 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11429 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11430 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11431 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11432 SIGTRAP.
11433
11434 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11435 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11436
11437 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11438 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11439 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11440 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11441 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11442 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11443 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
11444 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
11445 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
11446 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
11447 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
11448 targets that do not support new thread events, like
11449 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
11450 thread_count.
11451
11452 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
11453 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
11454 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
11455 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
11456
11457 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
11458 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
11459 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
11460 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
11461 traps we can no longer explain. */
11462
11463 process_stratum_target *proc_target = nullptr;
11464 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
11465 if (inf->pspace == old_loc->pspace)
11466 {
11467 proc_target = inf->process_target ();
11468 break;
11469 }
11470 if (proc_target != nullptr)
11471 old_loc->events_till_retirement
11472 = 3 * (thread_count (proc_target) + 1);
11473 else
11474 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 1;
11475 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11476
11477 moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
11478 }
11479 else
11480 {
11481 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11482 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
11483 }
11484 }
11485 }
11486
11487 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
11488 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
11489 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
11490 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
11491 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
11492 are sorted first for the same address.
11493
11494 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
11495 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
11496
11497 bp_loc_first = NULL;
11498 wp_loc_first = NULL;
11499 awp_loc_first = NULL;
11500 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
11501
11502 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
11503 {
11504 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
11505 non-NULL. */
11506 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
11507 breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
11508
11509 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
11510 || !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)
11511 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
11512 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
11513 `struct bp_location'. */
11514 || is_tracepoint (b))
11515 {
11516 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11517 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11518 continue;
11519 }
11520
11521 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
11522 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
11523 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
11524 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
11525 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
11526 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
11527 else
11528 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
11529
11530 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
11531 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
11532 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
11533 {
11534 *loc_first_p = loc;
11535 loc->duplicate = 0;
11536
11537 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
11538 {
11539 loc->needs_update = 1;
11540 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11541 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11542 }
11543 continue;
11544 }
11545
11546
11547 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
11548 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
11549 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
11550 if (loc->inserted)
11551 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
11552 loc->duplicate = 1;
11553
11554 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11555 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11556 }
11557
11558 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
11559 {
11560 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
11561 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
11562 else
11563 {
11564 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
11565 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
11566 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
11567 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
11568 only update conditions for locations that are marked
11569 "needs_update". */
11570 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
11571 }
11572 }
11573
11574 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
11575 download_tracepoint_locations ();
11576 }
11577
11578 void
11579 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
11580 {
11581 for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
11582 {
11583 struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
11584 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
11585 {
11586 decref_bp_location (&loc);
11587 unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
11588 --ix;
11589 }
11590 }
11591 }
11592
11593 static void
11594 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11595 {
11596
11597 try
11598 {
11599 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
11600 }
11601 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
11602 {
11603 }
11604 }
11605
11606 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
11607
11608 static void
11609 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat *bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
11610 {
11611 bpstat *bs;
11612
11613 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
11614 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
11615 {
11616 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
11617 bs->old_val = NULL;
11618 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
11619 }
11620 }
11621
11622 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
11623 static int
11624 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
11625 {
11626 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
11627
11628 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
11629 return 0;
11630 }
11631
11632 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
11633 callbacks. */
11634
11635 static void
11636 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
11637 {
11638 struct value_print_options opts;
11639
11640 get_user_print_options (&opts);
11641
11642 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
11643 single string. */
11644 if (b->loc == NULL)
11645 {
11646 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
11647 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
11648 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
11649 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
11650 {
11651 gdb_printf (_(" (%s) pending."),
11652 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
11653 }
11654 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
11655 {
11656 gdb_printf (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
11657 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
11658 b->extra_string.get ());
11659 }
11660 else
11661 {
11662 gdb_printf (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
11663 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
11664 b->extra_string.get ());
11665 }
11666 }
11667 else
11668 {
11669 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
11670 gdb_printf (" at %ps",
11671 styled_string (address_style.style (),
11672 paddress (b->loc->gdbarch,
11673 b->loc->address)));
11674 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
11675 {
11676 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
11677 more nicely. */
11678 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
11679 {
11680 const char *filename
11681 = symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab);
11682 gdb_printf (": file %ps, line %d.",
11683 styled_string (file_name_style.style (),
11684 filename),
11685 b->loc->line_number);
11686 }
11687 else
11688 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
11689 different file name, and this at least reflects the
11690 real situation somewhat. */
11691 gdb_printf (": %s.",
11692 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
11693 }
11694
11695 if (b->loc->next)
11696 {
11697 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11698 int n = 0;
11699 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11700 ++n;
11701 gdb_printf (" (%d locations)", n);
11702 }
11703 }
11704 }
11705
11706 /* See breakpoint.h. */
11707
11708 bp_location_range breakpoint::locations ()
11709 {
11710 return bp_location_range (this->loc);
11711 }
11712
11713 static struct bp_location *
11714 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
11715 {
11716 return new bp_location (self);
11717 }
11718
11719 static void
11720 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
11721 {
11722 /* Nothing to re-set. */
11723 }
11724
11725 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
11726 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
11727
11728 static int
11729 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
11730 {
11731 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11732 }
11733
11734 static int
11735 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
11736 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
11737 {
11738 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11739 }
11740
11741 static int
11742 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
11743 const address_space *aspace,
11744 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
11745 const target_waitstatus &ws)
11746 {
11747 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11748 }
11749
11750 static void
11751 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat *bs)
11752 {
11753 /* Always stop. */
11754 }
11755
11756 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
11757 errors. */
11758
11759 static int
11760 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
11761 {
11762 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11763 }
11764
11765 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
11766 errors. */
11767
11768 static int
11769 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
11770 {
11771 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11772 }
11773
11774 static enum print_stop_action
11775 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat *bs)
11776 {
11777 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11778 }
11779
11780 static void
11781 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
11782 struct ui_out *uiout)
11783 {
11784 /* nothing */
11785 }
11786
11787 static void
11788 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
11789 {
11790 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11791 }
11792
11793 static void
11794 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11795 {
11796 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11797 }
11798
11799 static void
11800 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
11801 (struct event_location *location,
11802 struct linespec_result *canonical,
11803 enum bptype type_wanted)
11804 {
11805 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11806 }
11807
11808 static void
11809 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11810 struct linespec_result *c,
11811 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
11812 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
11813 enum bptype type_wanted,
11814 enum bpdisp disposition,
11815 int thread,
11816 int task, int ignore_count,
11817 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
11818 int from_tty, int enabled,
11819 int internal, unsigned flags)
11820 {
11821 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11822 }
11823
11824 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
11825 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
11826 struct event_location *location,
11827 struct program_space *search_pspace)
11828 {
11829 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
11830 }
11831
11832 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
11833
11834 static int
11835 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
11836 {
11837 return 1;
11838 }
11839
11840 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
11841
11842 static void
11843 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstat *bs)
11844 {
11845 /* Nothing to do. */
11846 }
11847
11848 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
11849 {
11850 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
11851 base_breakpoint_re_set,
11852 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
11853 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
11854 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
11855 base_breakpoint_check_status,
11856 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
11857 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
11858 base_breakpoint_print_it,
11859 NULL,
11860 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
11861 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
11862 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
11863 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
11864 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
11865 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
11866 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
11867 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
11868 };
11869
11870 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
11871
11872 static void
11873 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
11874 {
11875 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
11876 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
11877 {
11878 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
11879 delete_breakpoint (b);
11880 return;
11881 }
11882
11883 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
11884 }
11885
11886 static int
11887 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
11888 {
11889 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
11890
11891 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
11892 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
11893
11894 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
11895 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
11896 else
11897 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
11898 }
11899
11900 static int
11901 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
11902 {
11903 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
11904 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
11905 else
11906 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
11907 }
11908
11909 static int
11910 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
11911 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
11912 const target_waitstatus &ws)
11913 {
11914 if (ws.kind () != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
11915 || ws.sig () != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
11916 return 0;
11917
11918 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
11919 aspace, bp_addr))
11920 return 0;
11921
11922 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
11923 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
11924 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
11925 return 0;
11926
11927 return 1;
11928 }
11929
11930 static int
11931 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
11932 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
11933 const target_waitstatus &ws)
11934 {
11935 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
11936 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
11937 {
11938 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
11939 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
11940 be set at the same address. */
11941 return 0;
11942 }
11943
11944 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
11945 }
11946
11947 static int
11948 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
11949 {
11950 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
11951
11952 return 1;
11953 }
11954
11955 static enum print_stop_action
11956 bkpt_print_it (bpstat *bs)
11957 {
11958 struct breakpoint *b;
11959 const struct bp_location *bl;
11960 int bp_temp;
11961 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11962
11963 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
11964
11965 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
11966 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
11967
11968 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
11969 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
11970 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
11971 bl->address,
11972 b->number, 1);
11973 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
11974 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
11975
11976 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
11977 {
11978 uiout->field_string ("reason",
11979 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
11980 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
11981 }
11982 if (bp_temp)
11983 uiout->message ("Temporary breakpoint %pF, ",
11984 signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
11985 else
11986 uiout->message ("Breakpoint %pF, ",
11987 signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
11988
11989 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
11990 }
11991
11992 static void
11993 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
11994 {
11995 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
11996 return;
11997
11998 switch (b->type)
11999 {
12000 case bp_breakpoint:
12001 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12002 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12003 gdb_printf (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12004 else
12005 gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint"));
12006 gdb_printf (_(" %d"), b->number);
12007 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12008 gdb_printf (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12009 break;
12010 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12011 gdb_printf (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12012 break;
12013 case bp_dprintf:
12014 gdb_printf (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12015 break;
12016 }
12017
12018 say_where (b);
12019 }
12020
12021 static void
12022 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12023 {
12024 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12025 gdb_printf (fp, "tbreak");
12026 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12027 gdb_printf (fp, "break");
12028 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12029 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12030 gdb_printf (fp, "thbreak");
12031 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12032 gdb_printf (fp, "hbreak");
12033 else
12034 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12035 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12036
12037 gdb_printf (fp, " %s",
12038 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12039
12040 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12041 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12042 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12043 gdb_printf (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string.get ());
12044
12045 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12046 }
12047
12048 static void
12049 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12050 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12051 enum bptype type_wanted)
12052 {
12053 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12054 }
12055
12056 static void
12057 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12058 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12059 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12060 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12061 enum bptype type_wanted,
12062 enum bpdisp disposition,
12063 int thread,
12064 int task, int ignore_count,
12065 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12066 int from_tty, int enabled,
12067 int internal, unsigned flags)
12068 {
12069 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12070 std::move (cond_string),
12071 std::move (extra_string),
12072 type_wanted,
12073 disposition, thread, task,
12074 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12075 enabled, internal, flags);
12076 }
12077
12078 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12079 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12080 struct event_location *location,
12081 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12082 {
12083 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12084 }
12085
12086 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12087
12088 static void
12089 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12090 {
12091 switch (b->type)
12092 {
12093 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12094 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12095 case bp_overlay_event:
12096 case bp_longjmp_master:
12097 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12098 case bp_exception_master:
12099 delete_breakpoint (b);
12100 break;
12101
12102 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12103 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12104 case bp_shlib_event:
12105
12106 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12107 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12108 case bp_thread_event:
12109 break;
12110 }
12111 }
12112
12113 static void
12114 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat *bs)
12115 {
12116 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12117 {
12118 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12119 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12120 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12121 objects (among other things). */
12122 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12123 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12124 }
12125 else
12126 bs->stop = 0;
12127 }
12128
12129 static enum print_stop_action
12130 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat *bs)
12131 {
12132 struct breakpoint *b;
12133
12134 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12135
12136 switch (b->type)
12137 {
12138 case bp_shlib_event:
12139 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12140 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12141 to shlib event" message.) */
12142 print_solib_event (0);
12143 break;
12144
12145 case bp_thread_event:
12146 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12147 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12148 gdb_printf (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12149 break;
12150
12151 case bp_overlay_event:
12152 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12153 gdb_printf (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12154 break;
12155
12156 case bp_longjmp_master:
12157 /* These should never be enabled. */
12158 gdb_printf (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12159 break;
12160
12161 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12162 /* These should never be enabled. */
12163 gdb_printf (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12164 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12165 break;
12166
12167 case bp_exception_master:
12168 /* These should never be enabled. */
12169 gdb_printf (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12170 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12171 break;
12172 }
12173
12174 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12175 }
12176
12177 static void
12178 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12179 {
12180 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12181 }
12182
12183 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12184
12185 static void
12186 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12187 {
12188 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12189 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12190 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12191 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12192 }
12193
12194 static void
12195 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat *bs)
12196 {
12197 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12198 }
12199
12200 static enum print_stop_action
12201 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat *bs)
12202 {
12203 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12204 }
12205
12206 static void
12207 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12208 {
12209 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12210 }
12211
12212 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12213
12214 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12215 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12216
12217 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12218 {
12219 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12220
12221 if (tp != NULL)
12222 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12223 }
12224
12225 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12226
12227 static int
12228 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12229 {
12230 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12231
12232 if (v == 0)
12233 {
12234 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12235 if needed. */
12236 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12237 }
12238
12239 return v;
12240 }
12241
12242 static int
12243 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12244 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12245 {
12246 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12247 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12248
12249 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12250 }
12251
12252 static void
12253 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12254 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12255 enum bptype type_wanted)
12256 {
12257 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12258
12259 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12260 lsal.canonical
12261 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12262 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12263 }
12264
12265 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12266 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12267 struct event_location *location,
12268 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12269 {
12270 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12271 if (sals.empty ())
12272 error (_("probe not found"));
12273 return sals;
12274 }
12275
12276 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12277
12278 static void
12279 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12280 {
12281 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12282 }
12283
12284 static int
12285 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12286 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12287 const target_waitstatus &ws)
12288 {
12289 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12290 tracepoints. */
12291 return 0;
12292 }
12293
12294 static void
12295 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12296 struct ui_out *uiout)
12297 {
12298 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12299 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12300 {
12301 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12302
12303 uiout->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n",
12304 string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12305 tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()));
12306 }
12307 }
12308
12309 static void
12310 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12311 {
12312 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12313 return;
12314
12315 switch (b->type)
12316 {
12317 case bp_tracepoint:
12318 gdb_printf (_("Tracepoint"));
12319 gdb_printf (_(" %d"), b->number);
12320 break;
12321 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12322 gdb_printf (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12323 gdb_printf (_(" %d"), b->number);
12324 break;
12325 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12326 gdb_printf (_("Static tracepoint"));
12327 gdb_printf (_(" %d"), b->number);
12328 break;
12329 default:
12330 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12331 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12332 }
12333
12334 say_where (b);
12335 }
12336
12337 static void
12338 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12339 {
12340 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12341
12342 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12343 gdb_printf (fp, "ftrace");
12344 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12345 gdb_printf (fp, "strace");
12346 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12347 gdb_printf (fp, "trace");
12348 else
12349 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12350 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12351
12352 gdb_printf (fp, " %s",
12353 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12354 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12355
12356 if (tp->pass_count)
12357 gdb_printf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12358 }
12359
12360 static void
12361 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12362 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12363 enum bptype type_wanted)
12364 {
12365 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12366 }
12367
12368 static void
12369 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12370 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12371 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12372 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12373 enum bptype type_wanted,
12374 enum bpdisp disposition,
12375 int thread,
12376 int task, int ignore_count,
12377 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12378 int from_tty, int enabled,
12379 int internal, unsigned flags)
12380 {
12381 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12382 std::move (cond_string),
12383 std::move (extra_string),
12384 type_wanted,
12385 disposition, thread, task,
12386 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12387 enabled, internal, flags);
12388 }
12389
12390 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12391 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12392 struct event_location *location,
12393 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12394 {
12395 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12396 }
12397
12398 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12399
12400 /* Virtual table for tracepoints on static probes. */
12401
12402 static void
12403 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12404 (struct event_location *location,
12405 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12406 enum bptype type_wanted)
12407 {
12408 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12409 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12410 }
12411
12412 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12413 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12414 struct event_location *location,
12415 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12416 {
12417 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12418 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12419 }
12420
12421 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12422
12423 static void
12424 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12425 {
12426 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12427
12428 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12429 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
12430
12431 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
12432 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
12433 3 - disconnect from target 1
12434 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
12435
12436 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
12437 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
12438 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
12439 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
12440 it all the time. */
12441 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
12442 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
12443 }
12444
12445 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
12446
12447 static void
12448 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12449 {
12450 gdb_printf (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
12451 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
12452 tp->extra_string.get ());
12453 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12454 }
12455
12456 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
12457 dprintf.
12458
12459 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
12460 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
12461 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
12462 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
12463 address are all handled. */
12464
12465 static void
12466 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstat *bs)
12467 {
12468 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
12469 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
12470 condition not be evaluated. */
12471 bs->stop = 0;
12472
12473 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
12474 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
12475 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
12476 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
12477 commands here throws. */
12478 counted_command_line cmds = std::move (bs->commands);
12479 gdb_assert (cmds != nullptr);
12480 execute_control_commands (cmds.get (), 0);
12481 }
12482
12483 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
12484 markers (`-m'). */
12485
12486 static void
12487 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12488 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12489 enum bptype type_wanted)
12490 {
12491 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12492 const char *arg_start, *arg;
12493
12494 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
12495 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
12496
12497 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
12498 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
12499 canonical->location
12500 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
12501
12502 lsal.canonical
12503 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12504 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12505 }
12506
12507 static void
12508 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12509 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12510 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12511 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12512 enum bptype type_wanted,
12513 enum bpdisp disposition,
12514 int thread,
12515 int task, int ignore_count,
12516 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12517 int from_tty, int enabled,
12518 int internal, unsigned flags)
12519 {
12520 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
12521
12522 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
12523 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
12524 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
12525 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
12526 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
12527 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
12528
12529 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
12530 {
12531 event_location_up location
12532 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
12533
12534 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
12535 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
12536 std::move (location), NULL,
12537 std::move (cond_string),
12538 std::move (extra_string),
12539 type_wanted, disposition,
12540 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
12541 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
12542 canonical->special_display);
12543 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
12544 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
12545 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
12546 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
12547 try to match up which of the newly found markers
12548 corresponds to this one */
12549 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
12550
12551 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
12552 }
12553 }
12554
12555 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12556 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12557 struct event_location *location,
12558 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12559 {
12560 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12561 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
12562
12563 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
12564 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
12565 {
12566 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
12567 sals.resize (1);
12568 return sals;
12569 }
12570 else
12571 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
12572 }
12573
12574 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
12575
12576 static int
12577 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
12578 {
12579 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
12580 }
12581
12582 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
12583 structures. */
12584
12585 void
12586 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
12587 {
12588 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
12589
12590 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
12591 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
12592 especial culprits.
12593
12594 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
12595 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
12596 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
12597 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
12598 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
12599 deleted.
12600
12601 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
12602 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
12603 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
12604 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
12605 was chosen. */
12606 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
12607 return;
12608
12609 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
12610 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
12611 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
12612 {
12613 struct breakpoint *related;
12614 struct watchpoint *w;
12615
12616 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
12617 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
12618 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
12619 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
12620 else
12621 w = NULL;
12622 if (w != NULL)
12623 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
12624
12625 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
12626 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
12627 related = related->related_breakpoint);
12628 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
12629 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
12630 }
12631
12632 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
12633 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
12634 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
12635 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
12636 if (bpt->number)
12637 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
12638
12639 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
12640 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
12641
12642 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
12643 if (b->next == bpt)
12644 {
12645 b->next = bpt->next;
12646 break;
12647 }
12648
12649 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
12650 been freed. */
12651 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
12652 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
12653 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
12654 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
12655 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
12656 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
12657 commands won't work. */
12658
12659 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
12660
12661 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
12662 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
12663 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
12664 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
12665 might be better design to have location completely
12666 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
12667 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
12668
12669 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
12670 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
12671 bpt->type = bp_none;
12672 delete bpt;
12673 }
12674
12675 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
12676 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
12677
12678 static void
12679 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
12680 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
12681 {
12682 struct breakpoint *related;
12683
12684 related = b;
12685 do
12686 {
12687 struct breakpoint *next;
12688
12689 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
12690 next = related->related_breakpoint;
12691
12692 if (next == related)
12693 {
12694 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
12695 function (related);
12696
12697 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
12698 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
12699 out. */
12700 break;
12701 }
12702 else
12703 function (related);
12704
12705 related = next;
12706 }
12707 while (related != b);
12708 }
12709
12710 static void
12711 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
12712 {
12713 dont_repeat ();
12714
12715 if (arg == 0)
12716 {
12717 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
12718
12719 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
12720 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
12721 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
12722 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
12723 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
12724 {
12725 breaks_to_delete = 1;
12726 break;
12727 }
12728
12729 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
12730 if (!from_tty
12731 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
12732 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
12733 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
12734 delete_breakpoint (b);
12735 }
12736 else
12737 map_breakpoint_numbers
12738 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
12739 {
12740 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
12741 });
12742 }
12743
12744 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
12745 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
12746 considered. */
12747
12748 static int
12749 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
12750 {
12751 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
12752 if ((pspace == NULL
12753 || loc->pspace == pspace)
12754 && !loc->shlib_disabled
12755 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
12756 return 0;
12757 return 1;
12758 }
12759
12760 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
12761 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
12762 Null names are ignored. */
12763
12764 static int
12765 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
12766 {
12767 struct bp_location *l;
12768 htab_up htab (htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, htab_eq_string, NULL,
12769 xcalloc, xfree));
12770
12771 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
12772 {
12773 const char **slot;
12774 const char *name = l->function_name.get ();
12775
12776 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
12777 if (name == NULL)
12778 continue;
12779
12780 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab.get (), (const void *) name,
12781 INSERT);
12782 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
12783 returns NULL. */
12784 if (*slot != NULL)
12785 return 1;
12786 *slot = name;
12787 }
12788
12789 return 0;
12790 }
12791
12792 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
12793 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
12794 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
12795 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
12796 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
12797 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
12798 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
12799 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
12800 The heuristic is:
12801
12802 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
12803 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
12804 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
12805 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
12806 in the sources, and output a warning.
12807
12808 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
12809 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
12810 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
12811 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
12812 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
12813 warning.
12814
12815 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
12816 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
12817 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
12818 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
12819 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
12820 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
12821 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
12822 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
12823 precisely because it confuses tools). */
12824
12825 static struct symtab_and_line
12826 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
12827 {
12828 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12829 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
12830 CORE_ADDR pc;
12831
12832 pc = sal.pc;
12833 if (sal.line)
12834 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
12835
12836 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
12837 {
12838 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
12839 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
12840 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
12841 marker.str_id.c_str ());
12842
12843 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
12844
12845 return sal;
12846 }
12847
12848 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
12849 by string ID. */
12850 if (!sal.explicit_pc
12851 && sal.line != 0
12852 && sal.symtab != NULL
12853 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12854 {
12855 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
12856 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
12857 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
12858
12859 if (!markers.empty ())
12860 {
12861 struct symbol *sym;
12862 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
12863 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12864 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
12865
12866 tpmarker = &markers[0];
12867
12868 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
12869
12870 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
12871 "found at previous line number"),
12872 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
12873
12874 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
12875 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
12876 uiout->text ("Now in ");
12877 if (sym)
12878 {
12879 uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
12880 function_name_style.style ());
12881 uiout->text (" at ");
12882 }
12883 uiout->field_string ("file",
12884 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
12885 file_name_style.style ());
12886 uiout->text (":");
12887
12888 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12889 {
12890 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
12891
12892 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
12893 }
12894
12895 uiout->field_signed ("line", sal2.line);
12896 uiout->text ("\n");
12897
12898 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
12899 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
12900
12901 b->location.reset (NULL);
12902 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
12903 explicit_loc.source_filename
12904 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
12905 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
12906 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
12907 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
12908
12909 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
12910 so. */
12911 }
12912 }
12913 return sal;
12914 }
12915
12916 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
12917 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
12918
12919 static int
12920 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
12921 {
12922 while (a && b)
12923 {
12924 if (a->address != b->address)
12925 return 0;
12926
12927 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
12928 return 0;
12929
12930 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
12931 return 0;
12932
12933 if (a->disabled_by_cond != b->disabled_by_cond)
12934 return 0;
12935
12936 a = a->next;
12937 b = b->next;
12938 }
12939
12940 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
12941 return 0;
12942
12943 return 1;
12944 }
12945
12946 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
12947 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
12948 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
12949
12950 static struct bp_location *
12951 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
12952 {
12953 struct bp_location head;
12954 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
12955 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
12956 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
12957
12958 if (pspace == NULL)
12959 {
12960 i = b->loc;
12961 b->loc = NULL;
12962 return i;
12963 }
12964
12965 head.next = NULL;
12966
12967 while (i != NULL)
12968 {
12969 if (i->pspace == pspace)
12970 {
12971 *i_link = i->next;
12972 i->next = NULL;
12973 hoisted->next = i;
12974 hoisted = i;
12975 }
12976 else
12977 i_link = &i->next;
12978 i = *i_link;
12979 }
12980
12981 return head.next;
12982 }
12983
12984 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
12985 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
12986 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
12987 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
12988 untouched. */
12989
12990 void
12991 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
12992 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
12993 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
12994 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
12995 {
12996 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
12997
12998 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
12999 {
13000 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13001 location. */
13002 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13003 gdb_printf (gdb_stderr,
13004 _("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13005 "multiple locations found\n"),
13006 b->number);
13007 return;
13008 }
13009
13010 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13011 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13012 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13013 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13014 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13015 individual locations. */
13016 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13017 return;
13018
13019 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13020
13021 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13022 {
13023 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13024
13025 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13026
13027 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13028
13029 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13030 old symtab. */
13031 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13032 {
13033 const char *s;
13034
13035 s = b->cond_string.get ();
13036 try
13037 {
13038 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13039 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13040 0);
13041 }
13042 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
13043 {
13044 new_loc->disabled_by_cond = true;
13045 }
13046 }
13047
13048 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13049 {
13050 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13051
13052 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13053 }
13054 }
13055
13056 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13057 breakpoints. */
13058 {
13059 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13060 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13061 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13062 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13063 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13064 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13065 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13066
13067 for (; e; e = e->next)
13068 {
13069 if ((!e->enabled || e->disabled_by_cond) && e->function_name)
13070 {
13071 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13072 {
13073 for (bp_location *l : b->locations ())
13074 {
13075 /* Ignore software vs hardware location type at
13076 this point, because with "set breakpoint
13077 auto-hw", after a re-set, locations that were
13078 hardware can end up as software, or vice versa.
13079 As mentioned above, this is an heuristic and in
13080 practice should give the correct answer often
13081 enough. */
13082 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l, true))
13083 {
13084 l->enabled = e->enabled;
13085 l->disabled_by_cond = e->disabled_by_cond;
13086 break;
13087 }
13088 }
13089 }
13090 else
13091 {
13092 for (bp_location *l : b->locations ())
13093 if (l->function_name
13094 && strcmp (e->function_name.get (),
13095 l->function_name.get ()) == 0)
13096 {
13097 l->enabled = e->enabled;
13098 l->disabled_by_cond = e->disabled_by_cond;
13099 break;
13100 }
13101 }
13102 }
13103 }
13104 }
13105
13106 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13107 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13108 }
13109
13110 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13111 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13112
13113 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13114 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13115 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13116 {
13117 struct gdb_exception exception;
13118
13119 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13120
13121 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13122
13123 try
13124 {
13125 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13126 }
13127 catch (gdb_exception_error &e)
13128 {
13129 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13130
13131 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13132 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13133 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13134 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13135 state, then user already saw the message about that
13136 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13137 errors. */
13138 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13139 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13140 || (b->loc != NULL
13141 && search_pspace != NULL
13142 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13143 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13144 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13145 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13146 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13147
13148 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13149 {
13150 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13151 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13152 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13153 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13154 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13155 which approach is better. */
13156 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13157 throw;
13158 }
13159
13160 exception = std::move (e);
13161 }
13162
13163 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13164 {
13165 for (auto &sal : sals)
13166 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13167 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13168 {
13169 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, extra_string;
13170 int thread, task;
13171
13172 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (sals, b->extra_string.get (),
13173 &cond_string, &thread,
13174 &task, &extra_string);
13175 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13176 if (cond_string)
13177 b->cond_string = std::move (cond_string);
13178 b->thread = thread;
13179 b->task = task;
13180 if (extra_string)
13181 b->extra_string = std::move (extra_string);
13182 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13183 }
13184
13185 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13186 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13187
13188 *found = 1;
13189 }
13190 else
13191 *found = 0;
13192
13193 return sals;
13194 }
13195
13196 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13197 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13198 locations. */
13199
13200 static void
13201 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13202 {
13203 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13204 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13205
13206 int found;
13207 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13208 filter_pspace, &found);
13209 if (found)
13210 expanded = std::move (sals);
13211
13212 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13213 {
13214 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13215 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13216 filter_pspace, &found);
13217 if (found)
13218 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13219 }
13220
13221 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13222 }
13223
13224 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13225 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13226
13227 static void
13228 create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location *location,
13229 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13230 enum bptype type_wanted)
13231 {
13232 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13233 }
13234
13235 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13236 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13237 breakpoint_ops. */
13238
13239 static void
13240 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13241 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13242 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13243 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13244 enum bptype type_wanted,
13245 enum bpdisp disposition,
13246 int thread,
13247 int task, int ignore_count,
13248 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13249 int from_tty, int enabled,
13250 int internal, unsigned flags)
13251 {
13252 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13253 std::move (cond_string),
13254 std::move (extra_string),
13255 type_wanted, disposition,
13256 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13257 enabled, internal, flags);
13258 }
13259
13260 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13261 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13262
13263 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13264 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13265 struct event_location *location,
13266 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13267 {
13268 struct linespec_result canonical;
13269
13270 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13271 NULL, 0, &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13272 b->filter.get ());
13273
13274 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13275 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13276
13277 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13278 {
13279 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13280 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13281 }
13282 return {};
13283 }
13284
13285 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13286
13287 static void
13288 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13289 {
13290 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13291 set_language (b->language);
13292
13293 b->ops->re_set (b);
13294 }
13295
13296 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13297 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13298
13299 void
13300 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13301 {
13302 {
13303 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13304 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13305 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13306
13307 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13308 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13309 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13310 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13311 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13312 we select the current frame.
13313
13314 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13315 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13316 have been reset. */
13317 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13318 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13319
13320 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13321 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13322 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13323 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13324
13325 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
13326 {
13327 try
13328 {
13329 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13330 }
13331 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
13332 {
13333 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13334 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13335 b->number);
13336 }
13337 }
13338
13339 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13340 }
13341
13342 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13343 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13344 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13345 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13346
13347 /* Now we can insert. */
13348 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13349 }
13350 \f
13351 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13352
13353 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13354 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13355 void
13356 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13357 {
13358 if (b->thread != -1)
13359 {
13360 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13361
13362 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13363 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13364 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13365 as well. */
13366 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13367 }
13368 }
13369
13370 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13371 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13372 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13373
13374 void
13375 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13376 {
13377 if (count < 0)
13378 count = 0;
13379
13380 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
13381 if (b->number == bptnum)
13382 {
13383 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13384 {
13385 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13386 gdb_printf (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13387 bptnum);
13388 return;
13389 }
13390
13391 b->ignore_count = count;
13392 if (from_tty)
13393 {
13394 if (count == 0)
13395 gdb_printf (_("Will stop next time "
13396 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13397 bptnum);
13398 else if (count == 1)
13399 gdb_printf (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13400 bptnum);
13401 else
13402 gdb_printf (_("Will ignore next %d "
13403 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13404 count, bptnum);
13405 }
13406 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13407 return;
13408 }
13409
13410 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13411 }
13412
13413 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13414
13415 static void
13416 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13417 {
13418 const char *p = args;
13419 int num;
13420
13421 if (p == 0)
13422 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
13423
13424 num = get_number (&p);
13425 if (num == 0)
13426 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
13427 if (*p == 0)
13428 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
13429
13430 set_ignore_count (num,
13431 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
13432 from_tty);
13433 if (from_tty)
13434 gdb_printf ("\n");
13435 }
13436 \f
13437
13438 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
13439 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
13440
13441 static void
13442 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
13443 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13444 {
13445 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
13446 {
13447 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
13448 bp_num_range.first);
13449 }
13450 else
13451 {
13452 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
13453 {
13454 bool match = false;
13455
13456 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
13457 if (b->number == i)
13458 {
13459 match = true;
13460 function (b);
13461 break;
13462 }
13463 if (!match)
13464 gdb_printf (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
13465 }
13466 }
13467 }
13468
13469 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
13470 ARGS. */
13471
13472 static void
13473 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
13474 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13475 {
13476 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
13477 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
13478
13479 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
13480
13481 while (!parser.finished ())
13482 {
13483 int num = parser.get_number ();
13484 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
13485 }
13486 }
13487
13488 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
13489 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
13490
13491 static struct bp_location *
13492 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
13493 {
13494 breakpoint *b = get_breakpoint (bp_num);
13495
13496 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
13497 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
13498
13499 if (loc_num == 0)
13500 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
13501
13502 int n = 0;
13503 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
13504 if (++n == loc_num)
13505 return loc;
13506
13507 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
13508 }
13509
13510 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
13511 enum class extract_bp_kind
13512 {
13513 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
13514 bp,
13515
13516 /* Extracting a location number. */
13517 loc,
13518 };
13519
13520 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
13521 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
13522 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
13523 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
13524 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
13525
13526 static int
13527 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
13528 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
13529 {
13530 const char *end = start;
13531 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
13532 if (num < 0)
13533 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
13534 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
13535 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
13536 int (end - start), start);
13537 if (num == 0)
13538 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
13539 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
13540 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
13541 int (end - start), start);
13542
13543 if (end_out != NULL)
13544 *end_out = end;
13545 return num;
13546 }
13547
13548 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
13549 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
13550 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
13551 are always positive integers. */
13552
13553 static std::pair<int, int>
13554 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
13555 const std::string &arg,
13556 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
13557 {
13558 std::pair<int, int> range;
13559 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
13560 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
13561 if (dash != std::string::npos)
13562 {
13563 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
13564 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
13565 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
13566 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
13567 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
13568 bp_loc);
13569
13570 const char *end;
13571 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
13572 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
13573 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
13574 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
13575
13576 if (range.first > range.second)
13577 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
13578 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
13579 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
13580 int (end - start_first), start_first);
13581 }
13582 else
13583 {
13584 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
13585 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
13586 range.second = range.first;
13587 }
13588 return range;
13589 }
13590
13591 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
13592 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
13593 BP_LOC_RANGE.
13594
13595 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
13596
13597 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
13598 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
13599 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
13600 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
13601 location number range.
13602 */
13603
13604 static void
13605 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
13606 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
13607 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
13608 {
13609 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
13610
13611 if (dot != std::string::npos)
13612 {
13613 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
13614
13615 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
13616 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
13617
13618 bp_num_range.first
13619 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
13620 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
13621
13622 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
13623 arg, dot + 1);
13624 }
13625 else
13626 {
13627 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
13628
13629 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
13630 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
13631 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
13632 }
13633 }
13634
13635 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
13636 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
13637
13638 static void
13639 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
13640 {
13641 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
13642 if (loc != NULL)
13643 {
13644 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && enable)
13645 error (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is invalid at location %d, "
13646 "cannot enable."), bp_num, loc_num);
13647
13648 if (loc->enabled != enable)
13649 {
13650 loc->enabled = enable;
13651 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
13652 }
13653 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
13654 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
13655 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
13656 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
13657 }
13658 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13659
13660 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
13661 }
13662
13663 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
13664 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
13665 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
13666 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
13667 location. */
13668
13669 static void
13670 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
13671 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
13672 bool enable)
13673 {
13674 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
13675 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
13676 }
13677
13678 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13679 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13680 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13681
13682 void
13683 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13684 {
13685 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
13686 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
13687 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
13688 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13689 return;
13690
13691 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13692
13693 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
13694 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
13695
13696 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
13697 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
13698 {
13699 for (bp_location *location : bpt->locations ())
13700 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
13701 }
13702
13703 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13704
13705 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
13706 }
13707
13708 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
13709 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
13710 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
13711 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
13712
13713 static void
13714 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
13715 {
13716 if (args == 0)
13717 {
13718 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
13719 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
13720 {
13721 if (enable)
13722 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
13723 else
13724 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
13725 }
13726 }
13727 else
13728 {
13729 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
13730
13731 while (!num.empty ())
13732 {
13733 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
13734
13735 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
13736
13737 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
13738 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
13739 {
13740 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
13741 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
13742 enable
13743 ? enable_breakpoint
13744 : disable_breakpoint);
13745 }
13746 else
13747 {
13748 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
13749 'x.y-z'. */
13750 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
13751 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
13752 }
13753 num = extract_arg (&args);
13754 }
13755 }
13756 }
13757
13758 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
13759 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
13760 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
13761 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
13762
13763 static void
13764 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13765 {
13766 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
13767 }
13768
13769 static void
13770 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
13771 int count)
13772 {
13773 int target_resources_ok;
13774
13775 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
13776 {
13777 int i;
13778 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
13779 target_resources_ok =
13780 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
13781 i + 1, 0);
13782 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
13783 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
13784 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
13785 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
13786 }
13787
13788 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
13789 {
13790 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
13791 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
13792
13793 try
13794 {
13795 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13796
13797 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
13798 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
13799 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
13800 }
13801 catch (const gdb_exception &e)
13802 {
13803 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
13804 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
13805 bpt->number);
13806 return;
13807 }
13808 }
13809
13810 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
13811
13812 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
13813 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
13814
13815 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
13816 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
13817 {
13818 for (bp_location *location : bpt->locations ())
13819 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
13820 }
13821
13822 bpt->disposition = disposition;
13823 bpt->enable_count = count;
13824 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13825
13826 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
13827 }
13828
13829
13830 void
13831 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13832 {
13833 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
13834 }
13835
13836 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
13837 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
13838 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
13839 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
13840
13841 static void
13842 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13843 {
13844 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
13845 }
13846
13847 static void
13848 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13849 {
13850 map_breakpoint_numbers
13851 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
13852 {
13853 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
13854 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
13855 {
13856 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
13857 });
13858 });
13859 }
13860
13861 static void
13862 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13863 {
13864 int count;
13865
13866 if (args == NULL)
13867 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
13868
13869 count = get_number (&args);
13870
13871 map_breakpoint_numbers
13872 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
13873 {
13874 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
13875 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
13876 {
13877 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
13878 });
13879 });
13880 }
13881
13882 static void
13883 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13884 {
13885 map_breakpoint_numbers
13886 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
13887 {
13888 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
13889 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
13890 {
13891 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
13892 });
13893 });
13894 }
13895 \f
13896 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
13897 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
13898 GDB itself. */
13899
13900 static void
13901 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
13902 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
13903 const bfd_byte *data)
13904 {
13905 for (breakpoint *bp : all_breakpoints ())
13906 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
13907 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
13908 {
13909 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
13910
13911 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
13912 {
13913 for (bp_location *loc : bp->locations ())
13914 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
13915 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
13916 && addr + len > loc->address)
13917 {
13918 wp->val = NULL;
13919 wp->val_valid = false;
13920 }
13921 }
13922 }
13923 }
13924
13925 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
13926
13927 void
13928 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13929 const address_space *aspace,
13930 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
13931 {
13932 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
13933 struct symtab_and_line sal;
13934 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
13935
13936 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
13937 {
13938 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
13939 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
13940 }
13941
13942 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
13943 sal.pc = pc;
13944 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
13945 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
13946 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
13947
13948 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
13949 }
13950
13951 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
13952
13953 int
13954 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
13955 {
13956 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
13957 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
13958
13959 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
13960
13961 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
13962 {
13963 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
13964 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
13965
13966 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
13967 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
13968
13969 return 1;
13970 }
13971 else
13972 return 0;
13973 }
13974
13975 /* See breakpoint.h. */
13976
13977 int
13978 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
13979 const address_space *aspace,
13980 CORE_ADDR pc)
13981 {
13982 for (bp_location *loc : bp->locations ())
13983 if (loc->inserted
13984 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
13985 return 1;
13986
13987 return 0;
13988 }
13989
13990 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
13991 PC. */
13992
13993 int
13994 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
13995 CORE_ADDR pc)
13996 {
13997 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
13998 {
13999 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14000 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14001 return 1;
14002 }
14003 return 0;
14004 }
14005
14006 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14007
14008 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14009 static void
14010 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14011 {
14012 tracepoint_count = num;
14013 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14014 }
14015
14016 static void
14017 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14018 {
14019 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14020 current_language);
14021 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
14022 (location.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */);
14023
14024 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14025 location.get (),
14026 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14027 0 /* tempflag */,
14028 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14029 0 /* Ignore count */,
14030 pending_break_support,
14031 ops,
14032 from_tty,
14033 1 /* enabled */,
14034 0 /* internal */, 0);
14035 }
14036
14037 static void
14038 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14039 {
14040 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14041 current_language);
14042 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14043 location.get (),
14044 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14045 0 /* tempflag */,
14046 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14047 0 /* Ignore count */,
14048 pending_break_support,
14049 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14050 from_tty,
14051 1 /* enabled */,
14052 0 /* internal */, 0);
14053 }
14054
14055 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14056
14057 static void
14058 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14059 {
14060 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14061 event_location_up location;
14062
14063 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14064 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14065 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14066 {
14067 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14068 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14069 }
14070 else
14071 {
14072 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14073 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14074 }
14075
14076 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14077 location.get (),
14078 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14079 0 /* tempflag */,
14080 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14081 0 /* Ignore count */,
14082 pending_break_support,
14083 ops,
14084 from_tty,
14085 1 /* enabled */,
14086 0 /* internal */, 0);
14087 }
14088
14089 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14090 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14091
14092 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14093 static int next_cmd;
14094
14095 static char *
14096 read_uploaded_action (void)
14097 {
14098 char *rslt = nullptr;
14099
14100 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14101 {
14102 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get ();
14103 next_cmd++;
14104 }
14105
14106 return rslt;
14107 }
14108
14109 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14110 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14111 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14112 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14113 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14114
14115 struct tracepoint *
14116 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14117 {
14118 const char *addr_str;
14119 char small_buf[100];
14120 struct tracepoint *tp;
14121
14122 if (utp->at_string)
14123 addr_str = utp->at_string.get ();
14124 else
14125 {
14126 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14127 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14128 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14129 user. */
14130 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14131 "source location, using raw address"),
14132 utp->number);
14133 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14134 addr_str = small_buf;
14135 }
14136
14137 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14138 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14139 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14140 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14141 utp->number);
14142
14143 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14144 current_language);
14145 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14146 location.get (),
14147 utp->cond_string.get (), -1, addr_str,
14148 false /* force_condition */,
14149 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14150 0 /* tempflag */,
14151 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14152 0 /* Ignore count */,
14153 pending_break_support,
14154 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14155 0 /* from_tty */,
14156 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14157 0 /* internal */,
14158 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14159 return NULL;
14160
14161 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14162 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14163 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14164
14165 if (utp->pass > 0)
14166 {
14167 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14168 tp->number);
14169
14170 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14171 }
14172
14173 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14174 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14175 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14176 function. */
14177 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14178 {
14179 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14180
14181 this_utp = utp;
14182 next_cmd = 0;
14183
14184 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14185
14186 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14187 }
14188 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14189 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14190 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14191 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14192 utp->number);
14193
14194 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14195 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14196 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14197
14198 return tp;
14199 }
14200
14201 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14202 omitted. */
14203
14204 static void
14205 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14206 {
14207 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14208 int num_printed;
14209
14210 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_tracepoint);
14211
14212 if (num_printed == 0)
14213 {
14214 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14215 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14216 else
14217 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14218 }
14219
14220 default_collect_info ();
14221 }
14222
14223 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14224 Not supported by all targets. */
14225 static void
14226 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14227 {
14228 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14229 }
14230
14231 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14232 Not supported by all targets. */
14233 static void
14234 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14235 {
14236 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14237 }
14238
14239 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14240 static void
14241 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14242 {
14243 dont_repeat ();
14244
14245 if (arg == 0)
14246 {
14247 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14248
14249 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14250 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14251 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14252 argument. */
14253 for (breakpoint *tp : all_tracepoints ())
14254 if (is_tracepoint (tp) && user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14255 {
14256 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14257 break;
14258 }
14259
14260 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14261 if (!from_tty
14262 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14263 {
14264 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
14265 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14266 delete_breakpoint (b);
14267 }
14268 }
14269 else
14270 map_breakpoint_numbers
14271 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
14272 {
14273 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
14274 });
14275 }
14276
14277 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14278
14279 static void
14280 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14281 {
14282 tp->pass_count = count;
14283 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14284 if (from_tty)
14285 gdb_printf (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14286 tp->number, count);
14287 }
14288
14289 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14290
14291 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14292 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14293 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14294
14295 static void
14296 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14297 {
14298 struct tracepoint *t1;
14299 ULONGEST count;
14300
14301 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14302 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14303 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14304
14305 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14306
14307 args = skip_spaces (args);
14308 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14309 {
14310 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14311 if (*args)
14312 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14313
14314 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
14315 {
14316 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14317 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14318 }
14319 }
14320 else if (*args == '\0')
14321 {
14322 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14323 if (t1)
14324 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14325 }
14326 else
14327 {
14328 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14329 while (!parser.finished ())
14330 {
14331 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14332 if (t1)
14333 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14334 }
14335 }
14336 }
14337
14338 struct tracepoint *
14339 get_tracepoint (int num)
14340 {
14341 for (breakpoint *t : all_tracepoints ())
14342 if (t->number == num)
14343 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14344
14345 return NULL;
14346 }
14347
14348 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14349 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14350 reconnecting). */
14351
14352 struct tracepoint *
14353 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14354 {
14355 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
14356 {
14357 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14358
14359 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14360 return t;
14361 }
14362
14363 return NULL;
14364 }
14365
14366 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14367 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14368 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14369 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14370
14371 struct tracepoint *
14372 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14373 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14374 {
14375 int tpnum;
14376 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14377
14378 if (parser != NULL)
14379 {
14380 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14381 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14382 }
14383 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14384 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14385 else
14386 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14387
14388 if (tpnum <= 0)
14389 {
14390 if (instring && *instring)
14391 gdb_printf (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14392 instring);
14393 else
14394 gdb_printf (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14395 return NULL;
14396 }
14397
14398 for (breakpoint *t : all_tracepoints ())
14399 if (t->number == tpnum)
14400 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14401
14402 gdb_printf ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
14403 return NULL;
14404 }
14405
14406 void
14407 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
14408 {
14409 if (b->thread != -1)
14410 gdb_printf (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
14411
14412 if (b->task != 0)
14413 gdb_printf (fp, " task %d", b->task);
14414
14415 gdb_printf (fp, "\n");
14416 }
14417
14418 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
14419 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
14420 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
14421 true. */
14422
14423 static void
14424 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
14425 bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
14426 {
14427 int any = 0;
14428 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
14429
14430 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
14431 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
14432
14433 /* See if we have anything to save. */
14434 for (breakpoint *tp : all_breakpoints ())
14435 {
14436 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
14437 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14438 continue;
14439
14440 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
14441 if (filter && !filter (tp))
14442 continue;
14443
14444 any = 1;
14445
14446 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
14447 {
14448 extra_trace_bits = 1;
14449
14450 /* We can stop searching. */
14451 break;
14452 }
14453 }
14454
14455 if (!any)
14456 {
14457 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
14458 return;
14459 }
14460
14461 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
14462
14463 stdio_file fp;
14464
14465 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
14466 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
14467 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
14468
14469 if (extra_trace_bits)
14470 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
14471
14472 for (breakpoint *tp : all_breakpoints ())
14473 {
14474 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
14475 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14476 continue;
14477
14478 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
14479 if (filter && !filter (tp))
14480 continue;
14481
14482 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
14483
14484 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
14485 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
14486 instead. */
14487
14488 if (tp->cond_string)
14489 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string.get ());
14490
14491 if (tp->ignore_count)
14492 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
14493
14494 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
14495 {
14496 fp.puts (" commands\n");
14497
14498 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
14499 try
14500 {
14501 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
14502 }
14503 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
14504 {
14505 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
14506 throw;
14507 }
14508
14509 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
14510 fp.puts (" end\n");
14511 }
14512
14513 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
14514 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
14515
14516 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
14517 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
14518 special, and not user visible. */
14519 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
14520 {
14521 int n = 1;
14522
14523 for (bp_location *loc : tp->locations ())
14524 {
14525 if (!loc->enabled)
14526 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
14527
14528 n++;
14529 }
14530 }
14531 }
14532
14533 if (extra_trace_bits && !default_collect.empty ())
14534 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect.c_str ());
14535
14536 if (from_tty)
14537 gdb_printf (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
14538 }
14539
14540 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
14541
14542 static void
14543 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14544 {
14545 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
14546 }
14547
14548 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
14549
14550 static void
14551 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14552 {
14553 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
14554 }
14555
14556 \f
14557 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
14558 locations used by several commands. */
14559
14560 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
14561 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
14562 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
14563 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
14564 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
14565 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
14566 \n\
14567 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
14568 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
14569 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
14570 \n\
14571 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
14572 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
14573 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
14574 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
14575 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
14576 \n\
14577 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
14578 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
14579 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
14580 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
14581 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
14582 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead."
14583
14584 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
14585 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
14586 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
14587 command. */
14588
14589 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
14590 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM]\n\
14591 \t[-force-condition] [if CONDITION]\n\
14592 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
14593 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
14594 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
14595 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
14596 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
14597 below.\n\
14598 \n\
14599 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
14600 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
14601 \n\
14602 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
14603 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
14604 \n\
14605 With the \"-force-condition\" flag, the condition is defined even when\n\
14606 it is invalid for all current locations.\n\
14607 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
14608 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
14609 conditions are different.\n\
14610 \n\
14611 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
14612
14613 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
14614 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
14615
14616 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
14617 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
14618
14619 void
14620 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
14621 cmd_func_ftype *func,
14622 completer_ftype *completer,
14623 void *user_data_catch,
14624 void *user_data_tcatch)
14625 {
14626 struct cmd_list_element *command;
14627
14628 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
14629 &catch_cmdlist);
14630 command->func = func;
14631 command->set_context (user_data_catch);
14632 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
14633
14634 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
14635 &tcatch_cmdlist);
14636 command->func = func;
14637 command->set_context (user_data_tcatch);
14638 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
14639 }
14640
14641 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
14642 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
14643
14644 static int
14645 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
14646 {
14647 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
14648 non-inline function. */
14649 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
14650 return 1;
14651
14652 return 0;
14653 }
14654
14655 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
14656 have been inlined. */
14657
14658 int
14659 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
14660 const target_waitstatus &ws)
14661 {
14662 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
14663 {
14664 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
14665 continue;
14666
14667 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
14668 {
14669 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
14670 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
14671 return 1;
14672 }
14673 }
14674
14675 return 0;
14676 }
14677
14678 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
14679
14680 void
14681 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
14682 {
14683 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
14684 if (loc->symtab != NULL && loc->symtab->compunit ()->objfile () == objfile)
14685 loc->symtab = NULL;
14686 }
14687
14688 void
14689 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
14690 {
14691 static int initialized = 0;
14692
14693 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14694
14695 if (initialized)
14696 return;
14697 initialized = 1;
14698
14699 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
14700 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
14701 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
14702 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
14703 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
14704 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
14705 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
14706 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
14707 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
14708 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
14709 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
14710 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
14711
14712 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
14713 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14714 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
14715 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
14716 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
14717 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
14718 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
14719 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
14720
14721 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
14722 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
14723 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14724 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
14725 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
14726 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
14727 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
14728 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
14729 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
14730 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
14731
14732 /* Internal breakpoints. */
14733 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
14734 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
14735 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
14736 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
14737 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
14738 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
14739
14740 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
14741 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
14742 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
14743 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
14744 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
14745 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
14746 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
14747
14748 /* Probe breakpoints. */
14749 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14750 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14751 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
14752 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
14753 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
14754 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
14755
14756 /* Watchpoints. */
14757 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
14758 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
14759 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
14760 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
14761 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
14762 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
14763 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
14764 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
14765 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
14766 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
14767 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
14768 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
14769 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
14770
14771 /* Masked watchpoints. */
14772 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
14773 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
14774 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
14775 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
14776 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
14777 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
14778 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
14779 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
14780 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
14781 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
14782
14783 /* Tracepoints. */
14784 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14785 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
14786 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
14787 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
14788 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
14789 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
14790 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
14791 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
14792 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
14793 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
14794
14795 /* Probe tracepoints. */
14796 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14797 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14798 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
14799 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
14800
14801 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
14802 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14803 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14804 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
14805 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
14806 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
14807
14808 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
14809 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
14810 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
14811 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
14812 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
14813 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
14814 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
14815 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
14816 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
14817 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
14818 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
14819
14820 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
14821 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
14822 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
14823 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
14824 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
14825 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
14826 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
14827 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
14828 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
14829 }
14830
14831 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
14832
14833 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
14834
14835 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14836
14837 cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
14838
14839 void _initialize_breakpoint ();
14840 void
14841 _initialize_breakpoint ()
14842 {
14843 struct cmd_list_element *c;
14844
14845 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
14846
14847 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib,
14848 "breakpoint");
14849 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile,
14850 "breakpoint");
14851 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change,
14852 "breakpoint");
14853
14854 breakpoint_chain = 0;
14855 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
14856 before a breakpoint is set. */
14857 breakpoint_count = 0;
14858
14859 tracepoint_count = 0;
14860
14861 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
14862 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
14863 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
14864
14865 commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
14866 commands_command, _("\
14867 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
14868 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
14869 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
14870 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
14871 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
14872 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
14873 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
14874 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
14875 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
14876
14877 const auto cc_opts = make_condition_command_options_def_group (nullptr);
14878 static std::string condition_command_help
14879 = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
14880 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
14881 Usage is `condition [OPTION] N COND', where N is an integer and COND\n\
14882 is an expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached.\n\
14883 \n\
14884 Options:\n\
14885 %OPTIONS%"), cc_opts);
14886
14887 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command,
14888 condition_command_help.c_str ());
14889 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, condition_completer);
14890
14891 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
14892 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
14893 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
14894 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
14895 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
14896 \n"
14897 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
14898 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
14899
14900 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
14901 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
14902 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
14903 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
14904 \n"
14905 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
14906 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
14907
14908 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
14909 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
14910 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
14911 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
14912 \n"
14913 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
14914 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
14915
14916 cmd_list_element *enable_cmd
14917 = add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
14918 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
14919 Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
14920 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
14921 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
14922 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
14923 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
14924 &enablelist, 1, &cmdlist);
14925
14926 add_com_alias ("en", enable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
14927
14928 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
14929 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
14930 Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
14931 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
14932 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
14933 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."),
14934 &enablebreaklist, 1, &enablelist);
14935
14936 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
14937 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
14938 Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
14939 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
14940 &enablebreaklist);
14941
14942 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
14943 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
14944 Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
14945 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
14946 &enablebreaklist);
14947
14948 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
14949 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
14950 Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
14951 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
14952 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
14953 &enablebreaklist);
14954
14955 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
14956 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
14957 Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
14958 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
14959 &enablelist);
14960
14961 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
14962 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
14963 Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
14964 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
14965 &enablelist);
14966
14967 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
14968 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
14969 Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
14970 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
14971 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
14972 &enablelist);
14973
14974 cmd_list_element *disable_cmd
14975 = add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
14976 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
14977 Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
14978 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
14979 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
14980 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
14981 &disablelist, 1, &cmdlist);
14982 add_com_alias ("dis", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
14983 add_com_alias ("disa", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
14984
14985 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
14986 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
14987 Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
14988 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
14989 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
14990 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
14991 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
14992 &disablelist);
14993
14994 cmd_list_element *delete_cmd
14995 = add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
14996 Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\
14997 Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
14998 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
14999 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15000 \n\
15001 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."),
15002 &deletelist, 1, &cmdlist);
15003 add_com_alias ("d", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15004 add_com_alias ("del", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15005
15006 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15007 Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15008 Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15009 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15010 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15011 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15012 &deletelist);
15013
15014 cmd_list_element *clear_cmd
15015 = add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15016 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15017 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15018 \n\
15019 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15020 is executing in.\n"
15021 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15022 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15023 add_com_alias ("cl", clear_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15024
15025 cmd_list_element *break_cmd
15026 = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15027 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15028 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15029 set_cmd_completer (break_cmd, location_completer);
15030
15031 add_com_alias ("b", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15032 add_com_alias ("br", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15033 add_com_alias ("bre", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15034 add_com_alias ("brea", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15035
15036 cmd_list_element *info_breakpoints_cmd
15037 = add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15038 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15039 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15040 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15041 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15042 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15043 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15044 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15045 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15046 \n\
15047 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15048 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15049 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15050 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15051 breakpoint set."));
15052
15053 add_info_alias ("b", info_breakpoints_cmd, 1);
15054
15055 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15056 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15057 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15058 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15059 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15060 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15061 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15062 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15063 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15064 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15065 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15066 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15067 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15068 \n\
15069 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15070 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15071 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15072 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15073 breakpoint set."),
15074 &maintenanceinfolist);
15075
15076 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, _("\
15077 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15078 &catch_cmdlist,
15079 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15080
15081 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, _("\
15082 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15083 &tcatch_cmdlist,
15084 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15085
15086 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15087 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15088 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15089 catch_load_command_1,
15090 NULL,
15091 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15092 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15093 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15094 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15095 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15096 catch_unload_command_1,
15097 NULL,
15098 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15099 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15100
15101 const auto opts = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr);
15102
15103 static const std::string watch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15104 Set a watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15105 Usage: watch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15106 \n\
15107 Options:\n\
15108 %OPTIONS%\n\
15109 \n\
15110 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15111 an expression changes."), opts);
15112 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command,
15113 watch_help.c_str ());
15114 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15115
15116 static const std::string rwatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15117 Set a read watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15118 Usage: rwatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15119 \n\
15120 Options:\n\
15121 %OPTIONS%\n\
15122 \n\
15123 A read watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15124 an expression is read."), opts);
15125 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command,
15126 rwatch_help.c_str ());
15127 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15128
15129 static const std::string awatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15130 Set an access watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15131 Usage: awatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15132 \n\
15133 Options:\n\
15134 %OPTIONS%\n\
15135 \n\
15136 An access watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value\n\
15137 of an expression is either read or written."), opts);
15138 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command,
15139 awatch_help.c_str ());
15140 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15141
15142 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15143 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15144
15145 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15146 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15147 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15148 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15149 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15150 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15151 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15152 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15153 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15154 hardware.)"),
15155 NULL,
15156 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15157 &setlist, &showlist);
15158
15159 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15160
15161 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15162
15163 cmd_list_element *trace_cmd
15164 = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15165 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15166 \n"
15167 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15168 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15169 set_cmd_completer (trace_cmd, location_completer);
15170
15171 add_com_alias ("tp", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 0);
15172 add_com_alias ("tr", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15173 add_com_alias ("tra", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15174 add_com_alias ("trac", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15175
15176 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15177 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15178 \n"
15179 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15180 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15181 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15182
15183 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15184 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15185 \n\
15186 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15187 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15188 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15189 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15190 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15191 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15192 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15193 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15194 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15195 \n\
15196 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15197 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15198 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15199 conditions are different.\n\
15200 \n\
15201 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15202 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15203 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15204
15205 cmd_list_element *info_tracepoints_cmd
15206 = add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15207 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15208 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15209 last tracepoint set."));
15210
15211 add_info_alias ("tp", info_tracepoints_cmd, 1);
15212
15213 cmd_list_element *delete_tracepoints_cmd
15214 = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15215 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15216 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15217 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15218 &deletelist);
15219 add_alias_cmd ("tr", delete_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15220
15221 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15222 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15223 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15224 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15225 &disablelist);
15226 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15227
15228 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15229 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15230 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15231 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15232 &enablelist);
15233 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15234
15235 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15236 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15237 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15238 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15239 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15240
15241 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint,
15242 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15243 &save_cmdlist,
15244 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15245
15246 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15247 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15248 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15249 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15250 session to restore them."),
15251 &save_cmdlist);
15252 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15253
15254 cmd_list_element *save_tracepoints_cmd
15255 = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15256 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15257 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15258 &save_cmdlist);
15259 set_cmd_completer (save_tracepoints_cmd, filename_completer);
15260
15261 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", save_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 0);
15262 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15263
15264 add_setshow_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance,
15265 _("\
15266 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15267 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15268 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15269 _("\
15270 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15271 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15272 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15273 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, &breakpoint_show_cmdlist,
15274 &setlist, &showlist);
15275
15276 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15277 &pending_break_support, _("\
15278 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15279 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15280 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15281 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15282 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15283 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15284 NULL,
15285 show_pending_break_support,
15286 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15287 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15288
15289 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15290
15291 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15292 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15293 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15294 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15295 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15296 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15297 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15298 NULL,
15299 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15300 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15301 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15302
15303 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15304 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15305 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15306 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15307 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15308 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15309 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15310 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15311 when execution stops."),
15312 NULL,
15313 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15314 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15315 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15316
15317 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15318 condition_evaluation_enums,
15319 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15320 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15321 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15322 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15323 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15324 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15325 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15326 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15327 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15328 be set to \"host\"."),
15329 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
15330 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
15331 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15332 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15333
15334 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
15335 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
15336 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
15337 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
15338 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
15339 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
15340 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
15341 or the start of the range\n\
15342 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
15343 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
15344 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
15345 \n\
15346 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
15347 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
15348 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
15349
15350 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
15351 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
15352 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
15353 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
15354 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
15355 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15356
15357 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
15358 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
15359 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15360 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15361 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
15362 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
15363 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
15364 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
15365 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
15366 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
15367 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15368 &setlist, &showlist);
15369
15370 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
15371 &dprintf_function, _("\
15372 Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
15373 Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
15374 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15375 &setlist, &showlist);
15376
15377 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
15378 &dprintf_channel, _("\
15379 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
15380 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
15381 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15382 &setlist, &showlist);
15383
15384 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
15385 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
15386 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15387 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15388 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
15389 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
15390 NULL,
15391 NULL,
15392 &setlist, &showlist);
15393
15394 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
15395 Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\
15396 Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\
15397 This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\
15398 This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
15399
15400 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = true;
15401
15402 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed,
15403 "breakpoint");
15404 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints,
15405 "breakpoint");
15406 }